Mercurial > emacs
annotate lispref/text.texi @ 70038:5e47fe08af2c
(SYSTEM_PURESIZE_EXTRA): Reduce to 24000.
author | Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 16 Apr 2006 18:05:06 +0000 |
parents | 5b6c4153d145 |
children | 2fe766ffb2c0 c156f6a9e7b5 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
6558 | 1 @c -*-texinfo-*- |
2 @c This is part of the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. | |
64889
e836425ee789
Update years in copyright notice; nfc.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
63950
diff
changeset
|
3 @c Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, |
68648
067115a6e738
Update years in copyright notice; nfc.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
68084
diff
changeset
|
4 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
6558 | 5 @c See the file elisp.texi for copying conditions. |
6 @setfilename ../info/text | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
7 @node Text, Non-ASCII Characters, Markers, Top |
6558 | 8 @chapter Text |
9 @cindex text | |
10 | |
11 This chapter describes the functions that deal with the text in a | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
12 buffer. Most examine, insert, or delete text in the current buffer, |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
13 often operating at point or on text adjacent to point. Many are |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
14 interactive. All the functions that change the text provide for undoing |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
15 the changes (@pxref{Undo}). |
6558 | 16 |
17 Many text-related functions operate on a region of text defined by two | |
18 buffer positions passed in arguments named @var{start} and @var{end}. | |
19 These arguments should be either markers (@pxref{Markers}) or numeric | |
20 character positions (@pxref{Positions}). The order of these arguments | |
21 does not matter; it is all right for @var{start} to be the end of the | |
22 region and @var{end} the beginning. For example, @code{(delete-region 1 | |
23 10)} and @code{(delete-region 10 1)} are equivalent. An | |
24 @code{args-out-of-range} error is signaled if either @var{start} or | |
25 @var{end} is outside the accessible portion of the buffer. In an | |
26 interactive call, point and the mark are used for these arguments. | |
27 | |
28 @cindex buffer contents | |
29 Throughout this chapter, ``text'' refers to the characters in the | |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
30 buffer, together with their properties (when relevant). Keep in mind |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
31 that point is always between two characters, and the cursor appears on |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
32 the character after point. |
6558 | 33 |
34 @menu | |
35 * Near Point:: Examining text in the vicinity of point. | |
36 * Buffer Contents:: Examining text in a general fashion. | |
37 * Comparing Text:: Comparing substrings of buffers. | |
38 * Insertion:: Adding new text to a buffer. | |
39 * Commands for Insertion:: User-level commands to insert text. | |
40 * Deletion:: Removing text from a buffer. | |
41 * User-Level Deletion:: User-level commands to delete text. | |
42 * The Kill Ring:: Where removed text sometimes is saved for later use. | |
43 * Undo:: Undoing changes to the text of a buffer. | |
44 * Maintaining Undo:: How to enable and disable undo information. | |
45 How to control how much information is kept. | |
46 * Filling:: Functions for explicit filling. | |
12098 | 47 * Margins:: How to specify margins for filling commands. |
23147 | 48 * Adaptive Fill:: Adaptive Fill mode chooses a fill prefix from context. |
6558 | 49 * Auto Filling:: How auto-fill mode is implemented to break lines. |
50 * Sorting:: Functions for sorting parts of the buffer. | |
51 * Columns:: Computing horizontal positions, and using them. | |
52 * Indentation:: Functions to insert or adjust indentation. | |
53 * Case Changes:: Case conversion of parts of the buffer. | |
54 * Text Properties:: Assigning Lisp property lists to text characters. | |
55 * Substitution:: Replacing a given character wherever it appears. | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
56 * Transposition:: Swapping two portions of a buffer. |
6558 | 57 * Registers:: How registers are implemented. Accessing the text or |
58 position stored in a register. | |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
59 * Base 64:: Conversion to or from base 64 encoding. |
39208
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
60 * MD5 Checksum:: Compute the MD5 ``message digest''/``checksum''. |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
61 * Atomic Changes:: Installing several buffer changes ``atomically''. |
6558 | 62 * Change Hooks:: Supplying functions to be run when text is changed. |
63 @end menu | |
64 | |
65 @node Near Point | |
66 @section Examining Text Near Point | |
67 | |
68 Many functions are provided to look at the characters around point. | |
69 Several simple functions are described here. See also @code{looking-at} | |
70 in @ref{Regexp Search}. | |
71 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
72 In the following four functions, ``beginning'' or ``end'' of buffer |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
73 refers to the beginning or end of the accessible portion. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
74 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
75 @defun char-after &optional position |
6558 | 76 This function returns the character in the current buffer at (i.e., |
77 immediately after) position @var{position}. If @var{position} is out of | |
78 range for this purpose, either before the beginning of the buffer, or at | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
79 or beyond the end, then the value is @code{nil}. The default for |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
80 @var{position} is point. |
6558 | 81 |
82 In the following example, assume that the first character in the | |
83 buffer is @samp{@@}: | |
84 | |
85 @example | |
86 @group | |
87 (char-to-string (char-after 1)) | |
88 @result{} "@@" | |
89 @end group | |
90 @end example | |
91 @end defun | |
92 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
93 @defun char-before &optional position |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
94 This function returns the character in the current buffer immediately |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
95 before position @var{position}. If @var{position} is out of range for |
50467
cb9a2b0620a3
(Near Point): Fix nonsense in char-before.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
49677
diff
changeset
|
96 this purpose, either at or before the beginning of the buffer, or beyond |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
97 the end, then the value is @code{nil}. The default for |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
98 @var{position} is point. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
99 @end defun |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
100 |
6558 | 101 @defun following-char |
102 This function returns the character following point in the current | |
103 buffer. This is similar to @code{(char-after (point))}. However, if | |
104 point is at the end of the buffer, then @code{following-char} returns 0. | |
105 | |
106 Remember that point is always between characters, and the terminal | |
107 cursor normally appears over the character following point. Therefore, | |
108 the character returned by @code{following-char} is the character the | |
109 cursor is over. | |
110 | |
111 In this example, point is between the @samp{a} and the @samp{c}. | |
112 | |
113 @example | |
114 @group | |
115 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
116 Gentlemen may cry ``Pea@point{}ce! Peace!,'' | |
117 but there is no peace. | |
118 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
119 @end group | |
120 | |
121 @group | |
122 (char-to-string (preceding-char)) | |
123 @result{} "a" | |
124 (char-to-string (following-char)) | |
125 @result{} "c" | |
126 @end group | |
127 @end example | |
128 @end defun | |
129 | |
130 @defun preceding-char | |
131 This function returns the character preceding point in the current | |
132 buffer. See above, under @code{following-char}, for an example. If | |
133 point is at the beginning of the buffer, @code{preceding-char} returns | |
134 0. | |
135 @end defun | |
136 | |
137 @defun bobp | |
138 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the beginning of the | |
139 buffer. If narrowing is in effect, this means the beginning of the | |
140 accessible portion of the text. See also @code{point-min} in | |
141 @ref{Point}. | |
142 @end defun | |
143 | |
144 @defun eobp | |
145 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the end of the buffer. | |
146 If narrowing is in effect, this means the end of accessible portion of | |
147 the text. See also @code{point-max} in @xref{Point}. | |
148 @end defun | |
149 | |
150 @defun bolp | |
151 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the beginning of a line. | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
152 @xref{Text Lines}. The beginning of the buffer (or of its accessible |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
153 portion) always counts as the beginning of a line. |
6558 | 154 @end defun |
155 | |
156 @defun eolp | |
157 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the end of a line. The | |
158 end of the buffer (or of its accessible portion) is always considered | |
159 the end of a line. | |
160 @end defun | |
161 | |
162 @node Buffer Contents | |
163 @section Examining Buffer Contents | |
164 | |
54041 | 165 This section describes functions that allow a Lisp program to |
6558 | 166 convert any portion of the text in the buffer into a string. |
167 | |
168 @defun buffer-substring start end | |
169 This function returns a string containing a copy of the text of the | |
170 region defined by positions @var{start} and @var{end} in the current | |
171 buffer. If the arguments are not positions in the accessible portion of | |
172 the buffer, @code{buffer-substring} signals an @code{args-out-of-range} | |
173 error. | |
174 | |
175 It is not necessary for @var{start} to be less than @var{end}; the | |
176 arguments can be given in either order. But most often the smaller | |
177 argument is written first. | |
178 | |
12067 | 179 If the text being copied has any text properties, these are copied into |
180 the string along with the characters they belong to. @xref{Text | |
181 Properties}. However, overlays (@pxref{Overlays}) in the buffer and | |
182 their properties are ignored, not copied. | |
183 | |
6558 | 184 @example |
185 @group | |
186 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
187 This is the contents of buffer foo | |
188 | |
189 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
190 @end group | |
191 | |
192 @group | |
193 (buffer-substring 1 10) | |
65321
cea6d5596fa2
(Buffer Contents): Use "\n" in examples' result strings.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
64889
diff
changeset
|
194 @result{} "This is t" |
6558 | 195 @end group |
196 @group | |
197 (buffer-substring (point-max) 10) | |
65321
cea6d5596fa2
(Buffer Contents): Use "\n" in examples' result strings.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
64889
diff
changeset
|
198 @result{} "he contents of buffer foo\n" |
6558 | 199 @end group |
200 @end example | |
201 @end defun | |
202 | |
13109
acb0ab49f4e7
Fix name of buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12775
diff
changeset
|
203 @defun buffer-substring-no-properties start end |
12067 | 204 This is like @code{buffer-substring}, except that it does not copy text |
205 properties, just the characters themselves. @xref{Text Properties}. | |
206 @end defun | |
207 | |
69903
5b6c4153d145
(Buffer Contents): Add NOPROPS arg to filter-buffer-substring.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
69578
diff
changeset
|
208 @defun filter-buffer-substring start end &optional delete noprops |
61116
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
209 This function passes the buffer text between @var{start} and @var{end} |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
210 through the filter functions specified by the variable |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
211 @code{buffer-substring-filters}, and returns the value from the last |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
212 filter function. If @code{buffer-substring-filters} is @code{nil}, |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
213 the value is the unaltered text from the buffer, what |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
214 @code{buffer-substring} would return. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
215 |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
216 If @var{delete} is non-@code{nil}, this function deletes the text |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
217 between @var{start} and @var{end} after copying it, like |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
218 @code{delete-and-extract-region}. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
219 |
69903
5b6c4153d145
(Buffer Contents): Add NOPROPS arg to filter-buffer-substring.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
69578
diff
changeset
|
220 If @var{noprops} is non-@code{nil}, the final string returned does not |
5b6c4153d145
(Buffer Contents): Add NOPROPS arg to filter-buffer-substring.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
69578
diff
changeset
|
221 include text properties, while the string passed through the filters |
5b6c4153d145
(Buffer Contents): Add NOPROPS arg to filter-buffer-substring.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
69578
diff
changeset
|
222 still includes text properties from the buffer text. |
5b6c4153d145
(Buffer Contents): Add NOPROPS arg to filter-buffer-substring.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
69578
diff
changeset
|
223 |
5b6c4153d145
(Buffer Contents): Add NOPROPS arg to filter-buffer-substring.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
69578
diff
changeset
|
224 Lisp code should use this function instead of @code{buffer-substring}, |
5b6c4153d145
(Buffer Contents): Add NOPROPS arg to filter-buffer-substring.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
69578
diff
changeset
|
225 @code{buffer-substring-no-properties}, |
61116
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
226 or @code{delete-and-extract-region} when copying into user-accessible |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
227 data structures such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, and registers. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
228 Major and minor modes can add functions to |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
229 @code{buffer-substring-filters} to alter such text as it is copied out |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
230 of the buffer. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
231 @end defun |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
232 |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
233 @defvar buffer-substring-filters |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
234 This variable should be a list of functions that accept a single |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
235 argument, a string, and return a string. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
236 @code{filter-buffer-substring} passes the buffer substring to the |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
237 first function in this list, and the return value of each function is |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
238 passed to the next function. The return value of the last function is |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
239 used as the return value of @code{filter-buffer-substring}. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
240 |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
241 As a special convention, point is set to the start of the buffer text |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
242 being operated on (i.e., the @var{start} argument for |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
243 @code{filter-buffer-substring}) before these functions are called. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
244 |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
245 If this variable is @code{nil}, no filtering is performed. |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
246 @end defvar |
171f1eda0401
(Buffer Contents): Add filter-buffer-substring and buffer-substring-filters.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60687
diff
changeset
|
247 |
6558 | 248 @defun buffer-string |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
249 This function returns the contents of the entire accessible portion of |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
250 the current buffer as a string. It is equivalent to |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
251 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
252 @example |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
253 (buffer-substring (point-min) (point-max)) |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
254 @end example |
6558 | 255 |
256 @example | |
257 @group | |
258 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
259 This is the contents of buffer foo | |
260 | |
261 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
262 | |
263 (buffer-string) | |
65321
cea6d5596fa2
(Buffer Contents): Use "\n" in examples' result strings.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
64889
diff
changeset
|
264 @result{} "This is the contents of buffer foo\n" |
6558 | 265 @end group |
266 @end example | |
267 @end defun | |
268 | |
51702
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
269 @tindex current-word |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
270 @defun current-word &optional strict really-word |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
271 This function returns the symbol (or word) at or near point, as a string. |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
272 The return value includes no text properties. |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
273 |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
274 If the optional argument @var{really-word} is non-@code{nil}, it finds a |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
275 word; otherwise, it finds a symbol (which includes both word |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
276 characters and symbol constituent characters). |
51702
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
277 |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
278 If the optional argument @var{strict} is non-@code{nil}, then point |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
279 must be in or next to the symbol or word---if no symbol or word is |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
280 there, the function returns @code{nil}. Otherwise, a nearby symbol or |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
281 word on the same line is acceptable. |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
282 @end defun |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
283 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
284 @defun thing-at-point thing |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
285 Return the @var{thing} around or next to point, as a string. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
286 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
287 The argument @var{thing} is a symbol which specifies a kind of syntactic |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
288 entity. Possibilities include @code{symbol}, @code{list}, @code{sexp}, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
289 @code{defun}, @code{filename}, @code{url}, @code{word}, @code{sentence}, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
290 @code{whitespace}, @code{line}, @code{page}, and others. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
291 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
292 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
293 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
294 Gentlemen may cry ``Pea@point{}ce! Peace!,'' |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
295 but there is no peace. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
296 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
297 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
298 (thing-at-point 'word) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
299 @result{} "Peace" |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
300 (thing-at-point 'line) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
301 @result{} "Gentlemen may cry ``Peace! Peace!,''\n" |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
302 (thing-at-point 'whitespace) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
303 @result{} nil |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
304 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
305 @end defun |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
306 |
6558 | 307 @node Comparing Text |
308 @section Comparing Text | |
309 @cindex comparing buffer text | |
310 | |
311 This function lets you compare portions of the text in a buffer, without | |
312 copying them into strings first. | |
313 | |
314 @defun compare-buffer-substrings buffer1 start1 end1 buffer2 start2 end2 | |
315 This function lets you compare two substrings of the same buffer or two | |
316 different buffers. The first three arguments specify one substring, | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
317 giving a buffer (or a buffer name) and two positions within the |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
318 buffer. The last three arguments specify the other substring in the |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
319 same way. You can use @code{nil} for @var{buffer1}, @var{buffer2}, or |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
320 both to stand for the current buffer. |
6558 | 321 |
322 The value is negative if the first substring is less, positive if the | |
323 first is greater, and zero if they are equal. The absolute value of | |
324 the result is one plus the index of the first differing characters | |
325 within the substrings. | |
326 | |
327 This function ignores case when comparing characters | |
12098 | 328 if @code{case-fold-search} is non-@code{nil}. It always ignores |
329 text properties. | |
6558 | 330 |
331 Suppose the current buffer contains the text @samp{foobarbar | |
332 haha!rara!}; then in this example the two substrings are @samp{rbar } | |
333 and @samp{rara!}. The value is 2 because the first substring is greater | |
334 at the second character. | |
335 | |
336 @example | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
337 (compare-buffer-substrings nil 6 11 nil 16 21) |
6558 | 338 @result{} 2 |
339 @end example | |
340 @end defun | |
341 | |
342 @node Insertion | |
12098 | 343 @section Inserting Text |
6558 | 344 @cindex insertion of text |
345 @cindex text insertion | |
346 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
347 @cindex insertion before point |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
348 @cindex before point, insertion |
6558 | 349 @dfn{Insertion} means adding new text to a buffer. The inserted text |
350 goes at point---between the character before point and the character | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
351 after point. Some insertion functions leave point before the inserted |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
352 text, while other functions leave it after. We call the former |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
353 insertion @dfn{after point} and the latter insertion @dfn{before point}. |
6558 | 354 |
355 Insertion relocates markers that point at positions after the | |
356 insertion point, so that they stay with the surrounding text | |
357 (@pxref{Markers}). When a marker points at the place of insertion, | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
358 insertion may or may not relocate the marker, depending on the marker's |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
359 insertion type (@pxref{Marker Insertion Types}). Certain special |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
360 functions such as @code{insert-before-markers} relocate all such markers |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
361 to point after the inserted text, regardless of the markers' insertion |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
362 type. |
6558 | 363 |
364 Insertion functions signal an error if the current buffer is | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
365 read-only or if they insert within read-only text. |
6558 | 366 |
12098 | 367 These functions copy text characters from strings and buffers along |
368 with their properties. The inserted characters have exactly the same | |
369 properties as the characters they were copied from. By contrast, | |
370 characters specified as separate arguments, not part of a string or | |
371 buffer, inherit their text properties from the neighboring text. | |
372 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
373 The insertion functions convert text from unibyte to multibyte in |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
374 order to insert in a multibyte buffer, and vice versa---if the text |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
375 comes from a string or from a buffer. However, they do not convert |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
376 unibyte character codes 128 through 255 to multibyte characters, not |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
377 even if the current buffer is a multibyte buffer. @xref{Converting |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
378 Representations}. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
379 |
6558 | 380 @defun insert &rest args |
381 This function inserts the strings and/or characters @var{args} into the | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
382 current buffer, at point, moving point forward. In other words, it |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
383 inserts the text before point. An error is signaled unless all |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
384 @var{args} are either strings or characters. The value is @code{nil}. |
6558 | 385 @end defun |
386 | |
387 @defun insert-before-markers &rest args | |
388 This function inserts the strings and/or characters @var{args} into the | |
389 current buffer, at point, moving point forward. An error is signaled | |
390 unless all @var{args} are either strings or characters. The value is | |
391 @code{nil}. | |
392 | |
393 This function is unlike the other insertion functions in that it | |
394 relocates markers initially pointing at the insertion point, to point | |
54041 | 395 after the inserted text. If an overlay begins at the insertion point, |
396 the inserted text falls outside the overlay; if a nonempty overlay | |
397 ends at the insertion point, the inserted text falls inside that | |
398 overlay. | |
6558 | 399 @end defun |
400 | |
49677
5c2d8e3b81b4
(Insertion): Don't show COUNT argument of `insert-char' as optional.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
401 @defun insert-char character count &optional inherit |
6558 | 402 This function inserts @var{count} instances of @var{character} into the |
65322
ce1b010dd1b5
(Insertion): Document precise type of `insert-char' arg COUNT.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
65321
diff
changeset
|
403 current buffer before point. The argument @var{count} should be an |
ce1b010dd1b5
(Insertion): Document precise type of `insert-char' arg COUNT.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
65321
diff
changeset
|
404 integer, and @var{character} must be a character. The value is @code{nil}. |
8644 | 405 |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
406 This function does not convert unibyte character codes 128 through 255 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
407 to multibyte characters, not even if the current buffer is a multibyte |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
408 buffer. @xref{Converting Representations}. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
409 |
8644 | 410 If @var{inherit} is non-@code{nil}, then the inserted characters inherit |
411 sticky text properties from the two characters before and after the | |
412 insertion point. @xref{Sticky Properties}. | |
6558 | 413 @end defun |
414 | |
415 @defun insert-buffer-substring from-buffer-or-name &optional start end | |
416 This function inserts a portion of buffer @var{from-buffer-or-name} | |
417 (which must already exist) into the current buffer before point. The | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
418 text inserted is the region between @var{start} and @var{end}. (These |
6558 | 419 arguments default to the beginning and end of the accessible portion of |
420 that buffer.) This function returns @code{nil}. | |
421 | |
422 In this example, the form is executed with buffer @samp{bar} as the | |
423 current buffer. We assume that buffer @samp{bar} is initially empty. | |
424 | |
425 @example | |
426 @group | |
427 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
428 We hold these truths to be self-evident, that all | |
429 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
430 @end group | |
431 | |
432 @group | |
433 (insert-buffer-substring "foo" 1 20) | |
434 @result{} nil | |
435 | |
436 ---------- Buffer: bar ---------- | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
437 We hold these truth@point{} |
6558 | 438 ---------- Buffer: bar ---------- |
439 @end group | |
440 @end example | |
441 @end defun | |
442 | |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
443 @defun insert-buffer-substring-no-properties from-buffer-or-name &optional start end |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
444 This is like @code{insert-buffer-substring} except that it does not |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
445 copy any text properties. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
446 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
447 |
6558 | 448 @xref{Sticky Properties}, for other insertion functions that inherit |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
449 text properties from the nearby text in addition to inserting it. |
8644 | 450 Whitespace inserted by indentation functions also inherits text |
451 properties. | |
6558 | 452 |
453 @node Commands for Insertion | |
454 @section User-Level Insertion Commands | |
455 | |
456 This section describes higher-level commands for inserting text, | |
457 commands intended primarily for the user but useful also in Lisp | |
458 programs. | |
459 | |
460 @deffn Command insert-buffer from-buffer-or-name | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
461 This command inserts the entire accessible contents of |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
462 @var{from-buffer-or-name} (which must exist) into the current buffer |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
463 after point. It leaves the mark after the inserted text. The value |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
464 is @code{nil}. |
6558 | 465 @end deffn |
466 | |
467 @deffn Command self-insert-command count | |
468 @cindex character insertion | |
469 @cindex self-insertion | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
470 This command inserts the last character typed; it does so @var{count} |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
471 times, before point, and returns @code{nil}. Most printing characters |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
472 are bound to this command. In routine use, @code{self-insert-command} |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
473 is the most frequently called function in Emacs, but programs rarely use |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
474 it except to install it on a keymap. |
6558 | 475 |
476 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument. | |
477 | |
67769
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
478 Self-insertion translates the input character through |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
479 @code{translation-table-for-input}. @xref{Translation of Characters}. |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
480 |
12067 | 481 This command calls @code{auto-fill-function} whenever that is |
28843 | 482 non-@code{nil} and the character inserted is in the table |
483 @code{auto-fill-chars} (@pxref{Auto Filling}). | |
6558 | 484 |
485 @c Cross refs reworded to prevent overfull hbox. --rjc 15mar92 | |
12067 | 486 This command performs abbrev expansion if Abbrev mode is enabled and |
6558 | 487 the inserted character does not have word-constituent |
67769
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
488 syntax. (@xref{Abbrevs}, and @ref{Syntax Class Table}.) It is also |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
489 responsible for calling @code{blink-paren-function} when the inserted |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
490 character has close parenthesis syntax (@pxref{Blinking}). |
25875 | 491 |
492 Do not try substituting your own definition of | |
493 @code{self-insert-command} for the standard one. The editor command | |
494 loop handles this function specially. | |
6558 | 495 @end deffn |
496 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
497 @deffn Command newline &optional number-of-newlines |
6558 | 498 This command inserts newlines into the current buffer before point. |
499 If @var{number-of-newlines} is supplied, that many newline characters | |
500 are inserted. | |
501 | |
502 @cindex newline and Auto Fill mode | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
503 This function calls @code{auto-fill-function} if the current column |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
504 number is greater than the value of @code{fill-column} and |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
505 @var{number-of-newlines} is @code{nil}. Typically what |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
506 @code{auto-fill-function} does is insert a newline; thus, the overall |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
507 result in this case is to insert two newlines at different places: one |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
508 at point, and another earlier in the line. @code{newline} does not |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
509 auto-fill if @var{number-of-newlines} is non-@code{nil}. |
6558 | 510 |
12098 | 511 This command indents to the left margin if that is not zero. |
512 @xref{Margins}. | |
513 | |
6558 | 514 The value returned is @code{nil}. In an interactive call, @var{count} |
515 is the numeric prefix argument. | |
516 @end deffn | |
517 | |
518 @deffn Command split-line | |
519 This command splits the current line, moving the portion of the line | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
520 after point down vertically so that it is on the next line directly |
6558 | 521 below where it was before. Whitespace is inserted as needed at the |
522 beginning of the lower line, using the @code{indent-to} function. | |
523 @code{split-line} returns the position of point. | |
524 | |
525 Programs hardly ever use this function. | |
526 @end deffn | |
527 | |
528 @defvar overwrite-mode | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
529 This variable controls whether overwrite mode is in effect. The value |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
530 should be @code{overwrite-mode-textual}, @code{overwrite-mode-binary}, |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
531 or @code{nil}. @code{overwrite-mode-textual} specifies textual |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
532 overwrite mode (treats newlines and tabs specially), and |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
533 @code{overwrite-mode-binary} specifies binary overwrite mode (treats |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
534 newlines and tabs like any other characters). |
6558 | 535 @end defvar |
536 | |
537 @node Deletion | |
12098 | 538 @section Deleting Text |
6558 | 539 |
540 @cindex deletion vs killing | |
541 Deletion means removing part of the text in a buffer, without saving | |
542 it in the kill ring (@pxref{The Kill Ring}). Deleted text can't be | |
543 yanked, but can be reinserted using the undo mechanism (@pxref{Undo}). | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
544 Some deletion functions do save text in the kill ring in some special |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
545 cases. |
6558 | 546 |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
547 All of the deletion functions operate on the current buffer. |
6558 | 548 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
549 @deffn Command erase-buffer |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
550 This function deletes the entire text of the current buffer |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
551 (@emph{not} just the accessible portion), leaving it |
6558 | 552 empty. If the buffer is read-only, it signals a @code{buffer-read-only} |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
553 error; if some of the text in it is read-only, it signals a |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
554 @code{text-read-only} error. Otherwise, it deletes the text without |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
555 asking for any confirmation. It returns @code{nil}. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
556 |
6558 | 557 Normally, deleting a large amount of text from a buffer inhibits further |
558 auto-saving of that buffer ``because it has shrunk''. However, | |
559 @code{erase-buffer} does not do this, the idea being that the future | |
560 text is not really related to the former text, and its size should not | |
561 be compared with that of the former text. | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
562 @end deffn |
6558 | 563 |
564 @deffn Command delete-region start end | |
27654
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
565 This command deletes the text between positions @var{start} and |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
566 @var{end} in the current buffer, and returns @code{nil}. If point was |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
567 inside the deleted region, its value afterward is @var{start}. |
12775
a8cd9be43025
Explain how delete-region alters point.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12282
diff
changeset
|
568 Otherwise, point relocates with the surrounding text, as markers do. |
6558 | 569 @end deffn |
570 | |
27654
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
571 @defun delete-and-extract-region start end |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
572 @tindex delete-and-extract-region |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
573 This function deletes the text between positions @var{start} and |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
574 @var{end} in the current buffer, and returns a string containing the |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
575 text just deleted. |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
576 |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
577 If point was inside the deleted region, its value afterward is |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
578 @var{start}. Otherwise, point relocates with the surrounding text, as |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
579 markers do. |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
580 @end defun |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
581 |
6558 | 582 @deffn Command delete-char count &optional killp |
583 This command deletes @var{count} characters directly after point, or | |
584 before point if @var{count} is negative. If @var{killp} is | |
585 non-@code{nil}, then it saves the deleted characters in the kill ring. | |
586 | |
587 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument, and | |
588 @var{killp} is the unprocessed prefix argument. Therefore, if a prefix | |
589 argument is supplied, the text is saved in the kill ring. If no prefix | |
590 argument is supplied, then one character is deleted, but not saved in | |
591 the kill ring. | |
592 | |
593 The value returned is always @code{nil}. | |
594 @end deffn | |
595 | |
596 @deffn Command delete-backward-char count &optional killp | |
597 @cindex delete previous char | |
598 This command deletes @var{count} characters directly before point, or | |
599 after point if @var{count} is negative. If @var{killp} is | |
600 non-@code{nil}, then it saves the deleted characters in the kill ring. | |
601 | |
602 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument, and | |
603 @var{killp} is the unprocessed prefix argument. Therefore, if a prefix | |
604 argument is supplied, the text is saved in the kill ring. If no prefix | |
605 argument is supplied, then one character is deleted, but not saved in | |
606 the kill ring. | |
607 | |
608 The value returned is always @code{nil}. | |
609 @end deffn | |
610 | |
611 @deffn Command backward-delete-char-untabify count &optional killp | |
612 @cindex tab deletion | |
613 This command deletes @var{count} characters backward, changing tabs | |
614 into spaces. When the next character to be deleted is a tab, it is | |
615 first replaced with the proper number of spaces to preserve alignment | |
616 and then one of those spaces is deleted instead of the tab. If | |
617 @var{killp} is non-@code{nil}, then the command saves the deleted | |
618 characters in the kill ring. | |
619 | |
620 Conversion of tabs to spaces happens only if @var{count} is positive. | |
621 If it is negative, exactly @minus{}@var{count} characters after point | |
622 are deleted. | |
623 | |
624 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument, and | |
625 @var{killp} is the unprocessed prefix argument. Therefore, if a prefix | |
626 argument is supplied, the text is saved in the kill ring. If no prefix | |
627 argument is supplied, then one character is deleted, but not saved in | |
628 the kill ring. | |
629 | |
630 The value returned is always @code{nil}. | |
631 @end deffn | |
632 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
633 @defopt backward-delete-char-untabify-method |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
634 This option specifies how @code{backward-delete-char-untabify} should |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
635 deal with whitespace. Possible values include @code{untabify}, the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
636 default, meaning convert a tab to many spaces and delete one; |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
637 @code{hungry}, meaning delete all tabs and spaces before point with |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
638 one command; @code{all} meaning delete all tabs, spaces and newlines |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
639 before point, and @code{nil}, meaning do nothing special for |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
640 whitespace characters. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
641 @end defopt |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
642 |
6558 | 643 @node User-Level Deletion |
644 @section User-Level Deletion Commands | |
645 | |
646 This section describes higher-level commands for deleting text, | |
647 commands intended primarily for the user but useful also in Lisp | |
648 programs. | |
649 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
650 @deffn Command delete-horizontal-space &optional backward-only |
6558 | 651 @cindex deleting whitespace |
652 This function deletes all spaces and tabs around point. It returns | |
653 @code{nil}. | |
654 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
655 If @var{backward-only} is non-@code{nil}, the function deletes |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
656 spaces and tabs before point, but not after point. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
657 |
6558 | 658 In the following examples, we call @code{delete-horizontal-space} four |
659 times, once on each line, with point between the second and third | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
660 characters on the line each time. |
6558 | 661 |
662 @example | |
663 @group | |
664 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
665 I @point{}thought | |
666 I @point{} thought | |
667 We@point{} thought | |
668 Yo@point{}u thought | |
669 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
670 @end group | |
671 | |
672 @group | |
673 (delete-horizontal-space) ; @r{Four times.} | |
674 @result{} nil | |
675 | |
676 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
677 Ithought | |
678 Ithought | |
679 Wethought | |
680 You thought | |
681 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
682 @end group | |
683 @end example | |
684 @end deffn | |
685 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
686 @deffn Command delete-indentation &optional join-following-p |
6558 | 687 This function joins the line point is on to the previous line, deleting |
688 any whitespace at the join and in some cases replacing it with one | |
689 space. If @var{join-following-p} is non-@code{nil}, | |
690 @code{delete-indentation} joins this line to the following line | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
691 instead. The function returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 692 |
693 If there is a fill prefix, and the second of the lines being joined | |
694 starts with the prefix, then @code{delete-indentation} deletes the | |
12098 | 695 fill prefix before joining the lines. @xref{Margins}. |
6558 | 696 |
697 In the example below, point is located on the line starting | |
698 @samp{events}, and it makes no difference if there are trailing spaces | |
699 in the preceding line. | |
700 | |
701 @smallexample | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
702 @group |
6558 | 703 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
704 When in the course of human | |
705 @point{} events, it becomes necessary | |
706 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
707 @end group |
6558 | 708 |
709 (delete-indentation) | |
710 @result{} nil | |
711 | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
712 @group |
6558 | 713 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
714 When in the course of human@point{} events, it becomes necessary | |
715 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
716 @end group |
6558 | 717 @end smallexample |
718 | |
719 After the lines are joined, the function @code{fixup-whitespace} is | |
720 responsible for deciding whether to leave a space at the junction. | |
721 @end deffn | |
722 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
723 @deffn Command fixup-whitespace |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
724 This function replaces all the horizontal whitespace surrounding point |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
725 with either one space or no space, according to the context. It |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
726 returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 727 |
728 At the beginning or end of a line, the appropriate amount of space is | |
729 none. Before a character with close parenthesis syntax, or after a | |
730 character with open parenthesis or expression-prefix syntax, no space is | |
731 also appropriate. Otherwise, one space is appropriate. @xref{Syntax | |
732 Class Table}. | |
733 | |
734 In the example below, @code{fixup-whitespace} is called the first time | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
735 with point before the word @samp{spaces} in the first line. For the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
736 second invocation, point is directly after the @samp{(}. |
6558 | 737 |
738 @smallexample | |
739 @group | |
740 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
741 This has too many @point{}spaces | |
742 This has too many spaces at the start of (@point{} this list) | |
743 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
744 @end group | |
745 | |
746 @group | |
747 (fixup-whitespace) | |
748 @result{} nil | |
749 (fixup-whitespace) | |
750 @result{} nil | |
751 @end group | |
752 | |
753 @group | |
754 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
755 This has too many spaces | |
756 This has too many spaces at the start of (this list) | |
757 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
758 @end group | |
759 @end smallexample | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
760 @end deffn |
6558 | 761 |
59880
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
762 @deffn Command just-one-space &optional n |
6558 | 763 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el |
764 This command replaces any spaces and tabs around point with a single | |
59880
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
765 space, or @var{n} spaces if @var{n} is specified. It returns |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
766 @code{nil}. |
6558 | 767 @end deffn |
768 | |
769 @deffn Command delete-blank-lines | |
770 This function deletes blank lines surrounding point. If point is on a | |
771 blank line with one or more blank lines before or after it, then all but | |
772 one of them are deleted. If point is on an isolated blank line, then it | |
773 is deleted. If point is on a nonblank line, the command deletes all | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
774 blank lines immediately following it. |
6558 | 775 |
776 A blank line is defined as a line containing only tabs and spaces. | |
777 | |
778 @code{delete-blank-lines} returns @code{nil}. | |
779 @end deffn | |
780 | |
781 @node The Kill Ring | |
782 @section The Kill Ring | |
783 @cindex kill ring | |
784 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
785 @dfn{Kill functions} delete text like the deletion functions, but save |
6558 | 786 it so that the user can reinsert it by @dfn{yanking}. Most of these |
787 functions have @samp{kill-} in their name. By contrast, the functions | |
788 whose names start with @samp{delete-} normally do not save text for | |
789 yanking (though they can still be undone); these are ``deletion'' | |
790 functions. | |
791 | |
792 Most of the kill commands are primarily for interactive use, and are | |
793 not described here. What we do describe are the functions provided for | |
794 use in writing such commands. You can use these functions to write | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
795 commands for killing text. When you need to delete text for internal |
6558 | 796 purposes within a Lisp function, you should normally use deletion |
797 functions, so as not to disturb the kill ring contents. | |
798 @xref{Deletion}. | |
799 | |
800 Killed text is saved for later yanking in the @dfn{kill ring}. This | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
801 is a list that holds a number of recent kills, not just the last text |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
802 kill. We call this a ``ring'' because yanking treats it as having |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
803 elements in a cyclic order. The list is kept in the variable |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
804 @code{kill-ring}, and can be operated on with the usual functions for |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
805 lists; there are also specialized functions, described in this section, |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
806 that treat it as a ring. |
6558 | 807 |
808 Some people think this use of the word ``kill'' is unfortunate, since | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
809 it refers to operations that specifically @emph{do not} destroy the |
6558 | 810 entities ``killed''. This is in sharp contrast to ordinary life, in |
811 which death is permanent and ``killed'' entities do not come back to | |
812 life. Therefore, other metaphors have been proposed. For example, the | |
813 term ``cut ring'' makes sense to people who, in pre-computer days, used | |
814 scissors and paste to cut up and rearrange manuscripts. However, it | |
815 would be difficult to change the terminology now. | |
816 | |
817 @menu | |
818 * Kill Ring Concepts:: What text looks like in the kill ring. | |
819 * Kill Functions:: Functions that kill text. | |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
820 * Yanking:: How yanking is done. |
6558 | 821 * Yank Commands:: Commands that access the kill ring. |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
822 * Low-Level Kill Ring:: Functions and variables for kill ring access. |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
823 * Internals of Kill Ring:: Variables that hold kill ring data. |
6558 | 824 @end menu |
825 | |
826 @node Kill Ring Concepts | |
827 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
828 @subsection Kill Ring Concepts | |
829 | |
830 The kill ring records killed text as strings in a list, most recent | |
831 first. A short kill ring, for example, might look like this: | |
832 | |
833 @example | |
834 ("some text" "a different piece of text" "even older text") | |
835 @end example | |
836 | |
837 @noindent | |
838 When the list reaches @code{kill-ring-max} entries in length, adding a | |
839 new entry automatically deletes the last entry. | |
840 | |
841 When kill commands are interwoven with other commands, each kill | |
842 command makes a new entry in the kill ring. Multiple kill commands in | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
843 succession build up a single kill ring entry, which would be yanked as a |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
844 unit; the second and subsequent consecutive kill commands add text to |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
845 the entry made by the first one. |
6558 | 846 |
847 For yanking, one entry in the kill ring is designated the ``front'' of | |
848 the ring. Some yank commands ``rotate'' the ring by designating a | |
849 different element as the ``front.'' But this virtual rotation doesn't | |
850 change the list itself---the most recent entry always comes first in the | |
851 list. | |
852 | |
853 @node Kill Functions | |
854 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
855 @subsection Functions for Killing | |
856 | |
857 @code{kill-region} is the usual subroutine for killing text. Any | |
858 command that calls this function is a ``kill command'' (and should | |
859 probably have @samp{kill} in its name). @code{kill-region} puts the | |
860 newly killed text in a new element at the beginning of the kill ring or | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
861 adds it to the most recent element. It determines automatically (using |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
862 @code{last-command}) whether the previous command was a kill command, |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
863 and if so appends the killed text to the most recent entry. |
6558 | 864 |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
865 @deffn Command kill-region start end &optional yank-handler |
6558 | 866 This function kills the text in the region defined by @var{start} and |
12098 | 867 @var{end}. The text is deleted but saved in the kill ring, along with |
868 its text properties. The value is always @code{nil}. | |
6558 | 869 |
870 In an interactive call, @var{start} and @var{end} are point and | |
871 the mark. | |
872 | |
873 @c Emacs 19 feature | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
874 If the buffer or text is read-only, @code{kill-region} modifies the kill |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
875 ring just the same, then signals an error without modifying the buffer. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
876 This is convenient because it lets the user use a series of kill |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
877 commands to copy text from a read-only buffer into the kill ring. |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
878 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
879 If @var{yank-handler} is non-@code{nil}, this puts that value onto |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
880 the string of killed text, as a @code{yank-handler} text property. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
881 @xref{Yanking}. Note that if @var{yank-handler} is @code{nil}, any |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
882 @code{yank-handler} properties present on the killed text are copied |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
883 onto the kill ring, like other text properties. |
6558 | 884 @end deffn |
885 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
886 @defopt kill-read-only-ok |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
887 If this option is non-@code{nil}, @code{kill-region} does not signal an |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
888 error if the buffer or text is read-only. Instead, it simply returns, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
889 updating the kill ring but not changing the buffer. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
890 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
891 |
6558 | 892 @deffn Command copy-region-as-kill start end |
893 This command saves the region defined by @var{start} and @var{end} on | |
12098 | 894 the kill ring (including text properties), but does not delete the text |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
895 from the buffer. It returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 896 |
12067 | 897 The command does not set @code{this-command} to @code{kill-region}, so a |
898 subsequent kill command does not append to the same kill ring entry. | |
899 | |
6558 | 900 Don't call @code{copy-region-as-kill} in Lisp programs unless you aim to |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
901 support Emacs 18. For newer Emacs versions, it is better to use |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
902 @code{kill-new} or @code{kill-append} instead. @xref{Low-Level Kill |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
903 Ring}. |
6558 | 904 @end deffn |
905 | |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
906 @node Yanking |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
907 @subsection Yanking |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
908 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
909 Yanking means inserting text from the kill ring, but it does |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
910 not insert the text blindly. Yank commands and some other commands |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
911 use @code{insert-for-yank} to perform special processing on the |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
912 text that they copy into the buffer. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
913 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
914 @defun insert-for-yank string |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
915 This function normally works like @code{insert} except that it doesn't |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
916 insert the text properties in the @code{yank-excluded-properties} |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
917 list. However, if any part of @var{string} has a non-@code{nil} |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
918 @code{yank-handler} text property, that property can do various |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
919 special processing on that part of the text being inserted. |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
920 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
921 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
922 @defun insert-buffer-substring-as-yank buf &optional start end |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
923 This function resembles @code{insert-buffer-substring} except that it |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
924 doesn't insert the text properties in the |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
925 @code{yank-excluded-properties} list. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
926 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
927 |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
928 You can put a @code{yank-handler} text property on all or part of |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
929 the text to control how it will be inserted if it is yanked. The |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
930 @code{insert-for-yank} function looks for that property. The property |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
931 value must be a list of one to four elements, with the following |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
932 format (where elements after the first may be omitted): |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
933 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
934 @example |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
935 (@var{function} @var{param} @var{noexclude} @var{undo}) |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
936 @end example |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
937 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
938 Here is what the elements do: |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
939 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
940 @table @var |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
941 @item function |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
942 When @var{function} is present and non-@code{nil}, it is called instead of |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
943 @code{insert} to insert the string. @var{function} takes one |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
944 argument---the string to insert. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
945 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
946 @item param |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
947 If @var{param} is present and non-@code{nil}, it replaces @var{string} |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
948 (or the part of @var{string} being processed) as the object passed to |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
949 @var{function} (or @code{insert}); for example, if @var{function} is |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
950 @code{yank-rectangle}, @var{param} should be a list of strings to |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
951 insert as a rectangle. |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
952 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
953 @item noexclude |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
954 If @var{noexclude} is present and non-@code{nil}, the normal removal of the |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
955 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead @var{function} is |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
956 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
957 if @var{function} adjusts point before or after inserting the object. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
958 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
959 @item undo |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
960 If @var{undo} is present and non-@code{nil}, it is a function that will be |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
961 called by @code{yank-pop} to undo the insertion of the current object. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
962 It is called with two arguments, the start and end of the current |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
963 region. @var{function} can set @code{yank-undo-function} to override |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
964 the @var{undo} value. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
965 @end table |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
966 |
6558 | 967 @node Yank Commands |
968 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
969 @subsection Functions for Yanking | |
970 | |
971 @dfn{Yanking} means reinserting an entry of previously killed text | |
12098 | 972 from the kill ring. The text properties are copied too. |
6558 | 973 |
974 @deffn Command yank &optional arg | |
975 @cindex inserting killed text | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
976 This command inserts before point the text at the front of the |
6558 | 977 kill ring. It positions the mark at the beginning of that text, and |
978 point at the end. | |
979 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
980 If @var{arg} is a non-@code{nil} list (which occurs interactively when |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
981 the user types @kbd{C-u} with no digits), then @code{yank} inserts the |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
982 text as described above, but puts point before the yanked text and |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
983 puts the mark after it. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
984 |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
985 If @var{arg} is a number, then @code{yank} inserts the @var{arg}th |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
986 most recently killed text---the @var{arg}th element of the kill ring |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
987 list, counted cyclically from the front, which is considered the |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
988 first element for this purpose. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
989 |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
990 @code{yank} does not alter the contents of the kill ring, unless it |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
991 used text provided by another program, in which case it pushes that text |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
992 onto the kill ring. However if @var{arg} is an integer different from |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
993 one, it rotates the kill ring to place the yanked string at the front. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
994 |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
995 @code{yank} returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 996 @end deffn |
997 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
998 @deffn Command yank-pop &optional arg |
6558 | 999 This command replaces the just-yanked entry from the kill ring with a |
1000 different entry from the kill ring. | |
1001 | |
1002 This is allowed only immediately after a @code{yank} or another | |
1003 @code{yank-pop}. At such a time, the region contains text that was just | |
1004 inserted by yanking. @code{yank-pop} deletes that text and inserts in | |
1005 its place a different piece of killed text. It does not add the deleted | |
1006 text to the kill ring, since it is already in the kill ring somewhere. | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1007 It does however rotate the kill ring to place the newly yanked string at |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1008 the front. |
6558 | 1009 |
1010 If @var{arg} is @code{nil}, then the replacement text is the previous | |
1011 element of the kill ring. If @var{arg} is numeric, the replacement is | |
1012 the @var{arg}th previous kill. If @var{arg} is negative, a more recent | |
1013 kill is the replacement. | |
1014 | |
1015 The sequence of kills in the kill ring wraps around, so that after the | |
1016 oldest one comes the newest one, and before the newest one goes the | |
1017 oldest. | |
1018 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1019 The return value is always @code{nil}. |
6558 | 1020 @end deffn |
1021 | |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1022 @defvar yank-undo-function |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1023 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, the function @code{yank-pop} uses |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1024 its value instead of @code{delete-region} to delete the text |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1025 inserted by the previous @code{yank} or |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1026 @code{yank-pop} command. The value must be a function of two |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1027 arguments, the start and end of the current region. |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1028 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1029 The function @code{insert-for-yank} automatically sets this variable |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1030 according to the @var{undo} element of the @code{yank-handler} |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1031 text property, if there is one. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1032 @end defvar |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1033 |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1034 @node Low-Level Kill Ring |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1035 @subsection Low-Level Kill Ring |
6558 | 1036 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1037 These functions and variables provide access to the kill ring at a |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1038 lower level, but still convenient for use in Lisp programs, because they |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1039 take care of interaction with window system selections |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1040 (@pxref{Window System Selections}). |
6558 | 1041 |
1042 @defun current-kill n &optional do-not-move | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1043 The function @code{current-kill} rotates the yanking pointer, which |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1044 designates the ``front'' of the kill ring, by @var{n} places (from newer |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1045 kills to older ones), and returns the text at that place in the ring. |
6558 | 1046 |
1047 If the optional second argument @var{do-not-move} is non-@code{nil}, | |
1048 then @code{current-kill} doesn't alter the yanking pointer; it just | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1049 returns the @var{n}th kill, counting from the current yanking pointer. |
6558 | 1050 |
1051 If @var{n} is zero, indicating a request for the latest kill, | |
1052 @code{current-kill} calls the value of | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1053 @code{interprogram-paste-function} (documented below) before |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1054 consulting the kill ring. If that value is a function and calling it |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1055 returns a string, @code{current-kill} pushes that string onto the kill |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1056 ring and returns it. It also sets the yanking pointer to point to |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1057 that new entry, regardless of the value of @var{do-not-move}. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1058 Otherwise, @code{current-kill} does not treat a zero value for @var{n} |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1059 specially: it returns the entry pointed at by the yanking pointer and |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1060 does not move the yanking pointer. |
6558 | 1061 @end defun |
1062 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1063 @defun kill-new string &optional replace yank-handler |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1064 This function pushes the text @var{string} onto the kill ring and |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1065 makes the yanking pointer point to it. It discards the oldest entry |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1066 if appropriate. It also invokes the value of |
6558 | 1067 @code{interprogram-cut-function} (see below). |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1068 |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1069 If @var{replace} is non-@code{nil}, then @code{kill-new} replaces the |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1070 first element of the kill ring with @var{string}, rather than pushing |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1071 @var{string} onto the kill ring. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1072 |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1073 If @var{yank-handler} is non-@code{nil}, this puts that value onto |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1074 the string of killed text, as a @code{yank-handler} property. |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1075 @xref{Yanking}. Note that if @var{yank-handler} is @code{nil}, then |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1076 @code{kill-new} copies any @code{yank-handler} properties present on |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1077 @var{string} onto the kill ring, as it does with other text properties. |
6558 | 1078 @end defun |
1079 | |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
1080 @defun kill-append string before-p &optional yank-handler |
6558 | 1081 This function appends the text @var{string} to the first entry in the |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1082 kill ring and makes the yanking pointer point to the combined entry. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1083 Normally @var{string} goes at the end of the entry, but if |
6558 | 1084 @var{before-p} is non-@code{nil}, it goes at the beginning. This |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1085 function also invokes the value of @code{interprogram-cut-function} |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1086 (see below). This handles @var{yank-handler} just like |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1087 @code{kill-new}, except that if @var{yank-handler} is different from |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1088 the @code{yank-handler} property of the first entry of the kill ring, |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1089 @code{kill-append} pushes the concatenated string onto the kill ring, |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1090 instead of replacing the original first entry with it. |
6558 | 1091 @end defun |
1092 | |
1093 @defvar interprogram-paste-function | |
1094 This variable provides a way of transferring killed text from other | |
1095 programs, when you are using a window system. Its value should be | |
1096 @code{nil} or a function of no arguments. | |
1097 | |
1098 If the value is a function, @code{current-kill} calls it to get the | |
1099 ``most recent kill''. If the function returns a non-@code{nil} value, | |
1100 then that value is used as the ``most recent kill''. If it returns | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1101 @code{nil}, then the front of the kill ring is used. |
6558 | 1102 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1103 The normal use of this hook is to get the window system's primary |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1104 selection as the most recent kill, even if the selection belongs to |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1105 another application. @xref{Window System Selections}. |
6558 | 1106 @end defvar |
1107 | |
1108 @defvar interprogram-cut-function | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1109 This variable provides a way of communicating killed text to other |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1110 programs, when you are using a window system. Its value should be |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1111 @code{nil} or a function of one required and one optional argument. |
6558 | 1112 |
1113 If the value is a function, @code{kill-new} and @code{kill-append} call | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1114 it with the new first element of the kill ring as the first argument. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1115 The second, optional, argument has the same meaning as the @var{push} |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1116 argument to @code{x-set-cut-buffer} (@pxref{Definition of |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1117 x-set-cut-buffer}) and only affects the second and later cut buffers. |
6558 | 1118 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1119 The normal use of this hook is to set the window system's primary |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1120 selection (and first cut buffer) from the newly killed text. |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1121 @xref{Window System Selections}. |
6558 | 1122 @end defvar |
1123 | |
1124 @node Internals of Kill Ring | |
1125 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1126 @subsection Internals of the Kill Ring | |
1127 | |
1128 The variable @code{kill-ring} holds the kill ring contents, in the | |
1129 form of a list of strings. The most recent kill is always at the front | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
1130 of the list. |
6558 | 1131 |
1132 The @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable points to a link in the | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1133 kill ring list, whose @sc{car} is the text to yank next. We say it |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1134 identifies the ``front'' of the ring. Moving |
6558 | 1135 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} to a different link is called |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1136 @dfn{rotating the kill ring}. We call the kill ring a ``ring'' because |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1137 the functions that move the yank pointer wrap around from the end of the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1138 list to the beginning, or vice-versa. Rotation of the kill ring is |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1139 virtual; it does not change the value of @code{kill-ring}. |
6558 | 1140 |
1141 Both @code{kill-ring} and @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} are Lisp | |
1142 variables whose values are normally lists. The word ``pointer'' in the | |
1143 name of the @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} indicates that the variable's | |
1144 purpose is to identify one element of the list for use by the next yank | |
1145 command. | |
1146 | |
1147 The value of @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is always @code{eq} to one | |
1148 of the links in the kill ring list. The element it identifies is the | |
1149 @sc{car} of that link. Kill commands, which change the kill ring, also | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1150 set this variable to the value of @code{kill-ring}. The effect is to |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1151 rotate the ring so that the newly killed text is at the front. |
6558 | 1152 |
1153 Here is a diagram that shows the variable @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} | |
1154 pointing to the second entry in the kill ring @code{("some text" "a | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
1155 different piece of text" "yet older text")}. |
6558 | 1156 |
1157 @example | |
1158 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1159 kill-ring ---- kill-ring-yank-pointer |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1160 | | |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1161 | v |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1162 | --- --- --- --- --- --- |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1163 --> | | |------> | | |--> | | |--> nil |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1164 --- --- --- --- --- --- |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
1165 | | | |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
1166 | | | |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
1167 | | -->"yet older text" |
6558 | 1168 | | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
1169 | --> "a different piece of text" |
6558 | 1170 | |
1171 --> "some text" | |
1172 @end group | |
1173 @end example | |
1174 | |
1175 @noindent | |
1176 This state of affairs might occur after @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank}) | |
1177 immediately followed by @kbd{M-y} (@code{yank-pop}). | |
1178 | |
1179 @defvar kill-ring | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1180 This variable holds the list of killed text sequences, most recently |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1181 killed first. |
6558 | 1182 @end defvar |
1183 | |
1184 @defvar kill-ring-yank-pointer | |
1185 This variable's value indicates which element of the kill ring is at the | |
1186 ``front'' of the ring for yanking. More precisely, the value is a tail | |
1187 of the value of @code{kill-ring}, and its @sc{car} is the kill string | |
1188 that @kbd{C-y} should yank. | |
1189 @end defvar | |
1190 | |
1191 @defopt kill-ring-max | |
1192 The value of this variable is the maximum length to which the kill | |
1193 ring can grow, before elements are thrown away at the end. The default | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1194 value for @code{kill-ring-max} is 60. |
6558 | 1195 @end defopt |
1196 | |
1197 @node Undo | |
1198 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1199 @section Undo | |
1200 @cindex redo | |
1201 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1202 Most buffers have an @dfn{undo list}, which records all changes made |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1203 to the buffer's text so that they can be undone. (The buffers that |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1204 don't have one are usually special-purpose buffers for which Emacs |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1205 assumes that undoing is not useful.) All the primitives that modify the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1206 text in the buffer automatically add elements to the front of the undo |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1207 list, which is in the variable @code{buffer-undo-list}. |
6558 | 1208 |
1209 @defvar buffer-undo-list | |
65369
822218f80ae4
2005-09-08 Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
65322
diff
changeset
|
1210 This buffer-local variable's value is the undo list of the current |
822218f80ae4
2005-09-08 Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
65322
diff
changeset
|
1211 buffer. A value of @code{t} disables the recording of undo information. |
6558 | 1212 @end defvar |
1213 | |
1214 Here are the kinds of elements an undo list can have: | |
1215 | |
1216 @table @code | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1217 @item @var{position} |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1218 This kind of element records a previous value of point; undoing this |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1219 element moves point to @var{position}. Ordinary cursor motion does not |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1220 make any sort of undo record, but deletion operations use these entries |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1221 to record where point was before the command. |
6558 | 1222 |
1223 @item (@var{beg} . @var{end}) | |
1224 This kind of element indicates how to delete text that was inserted. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
1225 Upon insertion, the text occupied the range @var{beg}--@var{end} in the |
6558 | 1226 buffer. |
1227 | |
10364 | 1228 @item (@var{text} . @var{position}) |
6558 | 1229 This kind of element indicates how to reinsert text that was deleted. |
10364 | 1230 The deleted text itself is the string @var{text}. The place to |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1231 reinsert it is @code{(abs @var{position})}. If @var{position} is |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1232 positive, point was at the beginning of the deleted text, otherwise it |
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1233 was at the end. |
6558 | 1234 |
1235 @item (t @var{high} . @var{low}) | |
1236 This kind of element indicates that an unmodified buffer became | |
1237 modified. The elements @var{high} and @var{low} are two integers, each | |
1238 recording 16 bits of the visited file's modification time as of when it | |
1239 was previously visited or saved. @code{primitive-undo} uses those | |
1240 values to determine whether to mark the buffer as unmodified once again; | |
1241 it does so only if the file's modification time matches those numbers. | |
1242 | |
1243 @item (nil @var{property} @var{value} @var{beg} . @var{end}) | |
1244 This kind of element records a change in a text property. | |
1245 Here's how you might undo the change: | |
1246 | |
1247 @example | |
1248 (put-text-property @var{beg} @var{end} @var{property} @var{value}) | |
1249 @end example | |
1250 | |
15760
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1251 @item (@var{marker} . @var{adjustment}) |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1252 This kind of element records the fact that the marker @var{marker} was |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1253 relocated due to deletion of surrounding text, and that it moved |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1254 @var{adjustment} character positions. Undoing this element moves |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1255 @var{marker} @minus{} @var{adjustment} characters. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1256 |
60687
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1257 @item (apply @var{funname} . @var{args}) |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1258 This is an extensible undo item, which is undone by calling |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1259 @var{funname} with arguments @var{args}. |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1260 |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1261 @item (apply @var{delta} @var{beg} @var{end} @var{funname} . @var{args}) |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1262 This is an extensible undo item, which records a change limited to the |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1263 range @var{beg} to @var{end}, which increased the size of the buffer |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1264 by @var{delta}. It is undone by calling @var{funname} with arguments |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1265 @var{args}. |
fddbd6936582
(Undo): Document extensible undo entries.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60679
diff
changeset
|
1266 |
67769
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1267 This kind of element enables undo limited to a region to determine |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1268 whether the element pertains to that region. |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1269 |
6558 | 1270 @item nil |
1271 This element is a boundary. The elements between two boundaries are | |
1272 called a @dfn{change group}; normally, each change group corresponds to | |
1273 one keyboard command, and undo commands normally undo an entire group as | |
1274 a unit. | |
1275 @end table | |
1276 | |
1277 @defun undo-boundary | |
1278 This function places a boundary element in the undo list. The undo | |
1279 command stops at such a boundary, and successive undo commands undo | |
1280 to earlier and earlier boundaries. This function returns @code{nil}. | |
1281 | |
11555
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1282 The editor command loop automatically creates an undo boundary before |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1283 each key sequence is executed. Thus, each undo normally undoes the |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1284 effects of one command. Self-inserting input characters are an |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1285 exception. The command loop makes a boundary for the first such |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1286 character; the next 19 consecutive self-inserting input characters do |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1287 not make boundaries, and then the 20th does, and so on as long as |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1288 self-inserting characters continue. |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1289 |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1290 All buffer modifications add a boundary whenever the previous undoable |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1291 change was made in some other buffer. This is to ensure that |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1292 each command makes a boundary in each buffer where it makes changes. |
11555
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1293 |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1294 Calling this function explicitly is useful for splitting the effects of |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1295 a command into more than one unit. For example, @code{query-replace} |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1296 calls @code{undo-boundary} after each replacement, so that the user can |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1297 undo individual replacements one by one. |
6558 | 1298 @end defun |
1299 | |
58748
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1300 @defvar undo-in-progress |
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1301 This variable is normally @code{nil}, but the undo commands bind it to |
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1302 @code{t}. This is so that various kinds of change hooks can tell when |
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1303 they're being called for the sake of undoing. |
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1304 @end defvar |
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1305 |
6558 | 1306 @defun primitive-undo count list |
1307 This is the basic function for undoing elements of an undo list. | |
1308 It undoes the first @var{count} elements of @var{list}, returning | |
1309 the rest of @var{list}. You could write this function in Lisp, | |
1310 but it is convenient to have it in C. | |
1311 | |
1312 @code{primitive-undo} adds elements to the buffer's undo list when it | |
1313 changes the buffer. Undo commands avoid confusion by saving the undo | |
1314 list value at the beginning of a sequence of undo operations. Then the | |
1315 undo operations use and update the saved value. The new elements added | |
12098 | 1316 by undoing are not part of this saved value, so they don't interfere with |
6558 | 1317 continuing to undo. |
58748
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1318 |
e347a194391a
(Undo): Document undo-in-progress.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57646
diff
changeset
|
1319 This function does not bind @code{undo-in-progress}. |
6558 | 1320 @end defun |
1321 | |
1322 @node Maintaining Undo | |
1323 @section Maintaining Undo Lists | |
1324 | |
1325 This section describes how to enable and disable undo information for | |
1326 a given buffer. It also explains how the undo list is truncated | |
1327 automatically so it doesn't get too big. | |
1328 | |
1329 Recording of undo information in a newly created buffer is normally | |
1330 enabled to start with; but if the buffer name starts with a space, the | |
1331 undo recording is initially disabled. You can explicitly enable or | |
1332 disable undo recording with the following two functions, or by setting | |
1333 @code{buffer-undo-list} yourself. | |
1334 | |
1335 @deffn Command buffer-enable-undo &optional buffer-or-name | |
1336 This command enables recording undo information for buffer | |
1337 @var{buffer-or-name}, so that subsequent changes can be undone. If no | |
1338 argument is supplied, then the current buffer is used. This function | |
1339 does nothing if undo recording is already enabled in the buffer. It | |
1340 returns @code{nil}. | |
1341 | |
1342 In an interactive call, @var{buffer-or-name} is the current buffer. | |
1343 You cannot specify any other buffer. | |
1344 @end deffn | |
1345 | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1346 @deffn Command buffer-disable-undo &optional buffer-or-name |
6558 | 1347 @cindex disable undo |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1348 This function discards the undo list of @var{buffer-or-name}, and disables |
6558 | 1349 further recording of undo information. As a result, it is no longer |
1350 possible to undo either previous changes or any subsequent changes. If | |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
1351 the undo list of @var{buffer-or-name} is already disabled, this function |
6558 | 1352 has no effect. |
1353 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1354 This function returns @code{nil}. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1355 @end deffn |
6558 | 1356 |
1357 As editing continues, undo lists get longer and longer. To prevent | |
1358 them from using up all available memory space, garbage collection trims | |
1359 them back to size limits you can set. (For this purpose, the ``size'' | |
1360 of an undo list measures the cons cells that make up the list, plus the | |
59838
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1361 strings of deleted text.) Three variables control the range of acceptable |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1362 sizes: @code{undo-limit}, @code{undo-strong-limit} and |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1363 @code{undo-outer-limit}. |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1364 |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1365 @defopt undo-limit |
6558 | 1366 This is the soft limit for the acceptable size of an undo list. The |
1367 change group at which this size is exceeded is the last one kept. | |
59838
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1368 @end defopt |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1369 |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1370 @defopt undo-strong-limit |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1371 This is the upper limit for the acceptable size of an undo list. The |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1372 change group at which this size is exceeded is discarded itself (along |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1373 with all older change groups). There is one exception: the very latest |
59838
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1374 change group is only discarded if it exceeds @code{undo-outer-limit}. |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1375 @end defopt |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1376 |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1377 @defopt undo-outer-limit |
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1378 If at garbage collection time the undo info for the current command |
59880
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
1379 exceeds this limit, Emacs discards the info and displays a warning. |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
1380 This is a last ditch limit to prevent memory overflow. |
59838
5e3ad3077141
(Maintaining Undo): Add `undo-outer-limit'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
59837
diff
changeset
|
1381 @end defopt |
6558 | 1382 |
1383 @node Filling | |
1384 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1385 @section Filling | |
1386 @cindex filling, explicit | |
1387 | |
1388 @dfn{Filling} means adjusting the lengths of lines (by moving the line | |
1389 breaks) so that they are nearly (but no greater than) a specified | |
1390 maximum width. Additionally, lines can be @dfn{justified}, which means | |
12098 | 1391 inserting spaces to make the left and/or right margins line up |
1392 precisely. The width is controlled by the variable @code{fill-column}. | |
1393 For ease of reading, lines should be no longer than 70 or so columns. | |
6558 | 1394 |
1395 You can use Auto Fill mode (@pxref{Auto Filling}) to fill text | |
1396 automatically as you insert it, but changes to existing text may leave | |
1397 it improperly filled. Then you must fill the text explicitly. | |
1398 | |
12067 | 1399 Most of the commands in this section return values that are not |
1400 meaningful. All the functions that do filling take note of the current | |
12098 | 1401 left margin, current right margin, and current justification style |
1402 (@pxref{Margins}). If the current justification style is | |
1403 @code{none}, the filling functions don't actually do anything. | |
1404 | |
1405 Several of the filling functions have an argument @var{justify}. | |
1406 If it is non-@code{nil}, that requests some kind of justification. It | |
1407 can be @code{left}, @code{right}, @code{full}, or @code{center}, to | |
1408 request a specific style of justification. If it is @code{t}, that | |
1409 means to use the current justification style for this part of the text | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1410 (see @code{current-justification}, below). Any other value is treated |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1411 as @code{full}. |
12098 | 1412 |
1413 When you call the filling functions interactively, using a prefix | |
1414 argument implies the value @code{full} for @var{justify}. | |
1415 | |
1416 @deffn Command fill-paragraph justify | |
6558 | 1417 @cindex filling a paragraph |
1418 This command fills the paragraph at or after point. If | |
12098 | 1419 @var{justify} is non-@code{nil}, each line is justified as well. |
6558 | 1420 It uses the ordinary paragraph motion commands to find paragraph |
38581 | 1421 boundaries. @xref{Paragraphs,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}. |
6558 | 1422 @end deffn |
1423 | |
25454 | 1424 @deffn Command fill-region start end &optional justify nosqueeze to-eop |
6558 | 1425 This command fills each of the paragraphs in the region from @var{start} |
12098 | 1426 to @var{end}. It justifies as well if @var{justify} is |
6558 | 1427 non-@code{nil}. |
1428 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1429 If @var{nosqueeze} is non-@code{nil}, that means to leave whitespace |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1430 other than line breaks untouched. If @var{to-eop} is non-@code{nil}, |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1431 that means to keep filling to the end of the paragraph---or the next hard |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1432 newline, if @code{use-hard-newlines} is enabled (see below). |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1433 |
6558 | 1434 The variable @code{paragraph-separate} controls how to distinguish |
1435 paragraphs. @xref{Standard Regexps}. | |
1436 @end deffn | |
1437 | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1438 @deffn Command fill-individual-paragraphs start end &optional justify citation-regexp |
6558 | 1439 This command fills each paragraph in the region according to its |
1440 individual fill prefix. Thus, if the lines of a paragraph were indented | |
1441 with spaces, the filled paragraph will remain indented in the same | |
1442 fashion. | |
1443 | |
1444 The first two arguments, @var{start} and @var{end}, are the beginning | |
1445 and end of the region to be filled. The third and fourth arguments, | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1446 @var{justify} and @var{citation-regexp}, are optional. If |
12098 | 1447 @var{justify} is non-@code{nil}, the paragraphs are justified as |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1448 well as filled. If @var{citation-regexp} is non-@code{nil}, it means the |
6558 | 1449 function is operating on a mail message and therefore should not fill |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1450 the header lines. If @var{citation-regexp} is a string, it is used as |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1451 a regular expression; if it matches the beginning of a line, that line |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1452 is treated as a citation marker. |
6558 | 1453 |
1454 Ordinarily, @code{fill-individual-paragraphs} regards each change in | |
1455 indentation as starting a new paragraph. If | |
1456 @code{fill-individual-varying-indent} is non-@code{nil}, then only | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1457 separator lines separate paragraphs. That mode can handle indented |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1458 paragraphs with additional indentation on the first line. |
6558 | 1459 @end deffn |
1460 | |
1461 @defopt fill-individual-varying-indent | |
1462 This variable alters the action of @code{fill-individual-paragraphs} as | |
1463 described above. | |
1464 @end defopt | |
1465 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1466 @deffn Command fill-region-as-paragraph start end &optional justify nosqueeze squeeze-after |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1467 This command considers a region of text as a single paragraph and fills |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1468 it. If the region was made up of many paragraphs, the blank lines |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1469 between paragraphs are removed. This function justifies as well as |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1470 filling when @var{justify} is non-@code{nil}. |
12067 | 1471 |
1472 In an interactive call, any prefix argument requests justification. | |
6558 | 1473 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1474 If @var{nosqueeze} is non-@code{nil}, that means to leave whitespace |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1475 other than line breaks untouched. If @var{squeeze-after} is |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1476 non-@code{nil}, it specifies a position in the region, and means don't |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1477 canonicalize spaces before that position. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1478 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1479 In Adaptive Fill mode, this command calls @code{fill-context-prefix} to |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1480 choose a fill prefix by default. @xref{Adaptive Fill}. |
6558 | 1481 @end deffn |
1482 | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1483 @deffn Command justify-current-line &optional how eop nosqueeze |
6558 | 1484 This command inserts spaces between the words of the current line so |
1485 that the line ends exactly at @code{fill-column}. It returns | |
1486 @code{nil}. | |
12067 | 1487 |
1488 The argument @var{how}, if non-@code{nil} specifies explicitly the style | |
1489 of justification. It can be @code{left}, @code{right}, @code{full}, | |
1490 @code{center}, or @code{none}. If it is @code{t}, that means to do | |
1491 follow specified justification style (see @code{current-justification}, | |
1492 below). @code{nil} means to do full justification. | |
1493 | |
63583
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1494 If @var{eop} is non-@code{nil}, that means do only left-justification |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1495 if @code{current-justification} specifies full justification. This is |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1496 used for the last line of a paragraph; even if the paragraph as a |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1497 whole is fully justified, the last line should not be. |
12067 | 1498 |
1499 If @var{nosqueeze} is non-@code{nil}, that means do not change interior | |
1500 whitespace. | |
6558 | 1501 @end deffn |
1502 | |
12067 | 1503 @defopt default-justification |
1504 This variable's value specifies the style of justification to use for | |
1505 text that doesn't specify a style with a text property. The possible | |
1506 values are @code{left}, @code{right}, @code{full}, @code{center}, or | |
12098 | 1507 @code{none}. The default value is @code{left}. |
12067 | 1508 @end defopt |
1509 | |
1510 @defun current-justification | |
1511 This function returns the proper justification style to use for filling | |
1512 the text around point. | |
1513 @end defun | |
1514 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1515 @defopt sentence-end-double-space |
57402
c50e857202e2
(Filling): Add anchor for definition of `sentence-end-double-space'.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
57253
diff
changeset
|
1516 @anchor{Definition of sentence-end-double-space} |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1517 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, a period followed by just one space |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1518 does not count as the end of a sentence, and the filling functions |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1519 avoid breaking the line at such a place. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1520 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1521 |
60679
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1522 @defopt sentence-end-without-period |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1523 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, a sentence can end without a |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1524 period. This is used for languages like Thai, where sentences end |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1525 with a double space but without a period. |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1526 @end defopt |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1527 |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1528 @defopt sentence-end-without-space |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1529 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a string of |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1530 characters that can end a sentence without following spaces. |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1531 @end defopt |
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
1532 |
12098 | 1533 @defvar fill-paragraph-function |
1534 This variable provides a way for major modes to override the filling of | |
1535 paragraphs. If the value is non-@code{nil}, @code{fill-paragraph} calls | |
1536 this function to do the work. If the function returns a non-@code{nil} | |
1537 value, @code{fill-paragraph} assumes the job is done, and immediately | |
1538 returns that value. | |
1539 | |
1540 The usual use of this feature is to fill comments in programming | |
1541 language modes. If the function needs to fill a paragraph in the usual | |
1542 way, it can do so as follows: | |
1543 | |
1544 @example | |
1545 (let ((fill-paragraph-function nil)) | |
1546 (fill-paragraph arg)) | |
1547 @end example | |
1548 @end defvar | |
1549 | |
1550 @defvar use-hard-newlines | |
1551 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, the filling functions do not delete | |
1552 newlines that have the @code{hard} text property. These ``hard | |
1553 newlines'' act as paragraph separators. | |
1554 @end defvar | |
1555 | |
1556 @node Margins | |
1557 @section Margins for Filling | |
1558 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1559 @defopt fill-prefix |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1560 This buffer-local variable specifies a string of text that appears at |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1561 the beginning |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1562 of normal text lines and should be disregarded when filling them. Any |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1563 line that fails to start with the fill prefix is considered the start of |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1564 a paragraph; so is any line that starts with the fill prefix followed by |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1565 additional whitespace. Lines that start with the fill prefix but no |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1566 additional whitespace are ordinary text lines that can be filled |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1567 together. The resulting filled lines also start with the fill prefix. |
12098 | 1568 |
1569 The fill prefix follows the left margin whitespace, if any. | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1570 @end defopt |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1571 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1572 @defopt fill-column |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1573 This buffer-local variable specifies the maximum width of filled lines. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1574 Its value should be an integer, which is a number of columns. All the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1575 filling, justification, and centering commands are affected by this |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1576 variable, including Auto Fill mode (@pxref{Auto Filling}). |
6558 | 1577 |
1578 As a practical matter, if you are writing text for other people to | |
1579 read, you should set @code{fill-column} to no more than 70. Otherwise | |
1580 the line will be too long for people to read comfortably, and this can | |
1581 make the text seem clumsy. | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1582 @end defopt |
6558 | 1583 |
1584 @defvar default-fill-column | |
1585 The value of this variable is the default value for @code{fill-column} in | |
1586 buffers that do not override it. This is the same as | |
1587 @code{(default-value 'fill-column)}. | |
1588 | |
1589 The default value for @code{default-fill-column} is 70. | |
1590 @end defvar | |
1591 | |
12067 | 1592 @deffn Command set-left-margin from to margin |
1593 This sets the @code{left-margin} property on the text from @var{from} to | |
1594 @var{to} to the value @var{margin}. If Auto Fill mode is enabled, this | |
1595 command also refills the region to fit the new margin. | |
1596 @end deffn | |
1597 | |
1598 @deffn Command set-right-margin from to margin | |
12098 | 1599 This sets the @code{right-margin} property on the text from @var{from} |
1600 to @var{to} to the value @var{margin}. If Auto Fill mode is enabled, | |
1601 this command also refills the region to fit the new margin. | |
12067 | 1602 @end deffn |
1603 | |
1604 @defun current-left-margin | |
1605 This function returns the proper left margin value to use for filling | |
1606 the text around point. The value is the sum of the @code{left-margin} | |
1607 property of the character at the start of the current line (or zero if | |
12098 | 1608 none), and the value of the variable @code{left-margin}. |
12067 | 1609 @end defun |
1610 | |
1611 @defun current-fill-column | |
1612 This function returns the proper fill column value to use for filling | |
1613 the text around point. The value is the value of the @code{fill-column} | |
1614 variable, minus the value of the @code{right-margin} property of the | |
1615 character after point. | |
1616 @end defun | |
1617 | |
1618 @deffn Command move-to-left-margin &optional n force | |
1619 This function moves point to the left margin of the current line. The | |
1620 column moved to is determined by calling the function | |
12098 | 1621 @code{current-left-margin}. If the argument @var{n} is non-@code{nil}, |
12067 | 1622 @code{move-to-left-margin} moves forward @var{n}@minus{}1 lines first. |
1623 | |
1624 If @var{force} is non-@code{nil}, that says to fix the line's | |
1625 indentation if that doesn't match the left margin value. | |
1626 @end deffn | |
1627 | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1628 @defun delete-to-left-margin &optional from to |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1629 This function removes left margin indentation from the text between |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1630 @var{from} and @var{to}. The amount of indentation to delete is |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1631 determined by calling @code{current-left-margin}. In no case does this |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1632 function delete non-whitespace. If @var{from} and @var{to} are omitted, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1633 they default to the whole buffer. |
12067 | 1634 @end defun |
1635 | |
12098 | 1636 @defun indent-to-left-margin |
1637 This is the default @code{indent-line-function}, used in Fundamental | |
1638 mode, Text mode, etc. Its effect is to adjust the indentation at the | |
1639 beginning of the current line to the value specified by the variable | |
1640 @code{left-margin}. This may involve either inserting or deleting | |
1641 whitespace. | |
1642 @end defun | |
1643 | |
1644 @defvar left-margin | |
1645 This variable specifies the base left margin column. In Fundamental | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1646 mode, @kbd{C-j} indents to this column. This variable automatically |
12098 | 1647 becomes buffer-local when set in any fashion. |
1648 @end defvar | |
1649 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1650 @defvar fill-nobreak-predicate |
59945
e568af229081
(Margins): fill-nobreak-predicate can be one function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59933
diff
changeset
|
1651 This variable gives major modes a way to specify not to break a line |
e568af229081
(Margins): fill-nobreak-predicate can be one function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59933
diff
changeset
|
1652 at certain places. Its value should be a list of functions, but a |
e568af229081
(Margins): fill-nobreak-predicate can be one function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59933
diff
changeset
|
1653 single function is also supported for compatibility. Whenever filling |
e568af229081
(Margins): fill-nobreak-predicate can be one function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59933
diff
changeset
|
1654 considers breaking the line at a certain place in the buffer, it calls |
e568af229081
(Margins): fill-nobreak-predicate can be one function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59933
diff
changeset
|
1655 each of these functions with no arguments and with point located at |
e568af229081
(Margins): fill-nobreak-predicate can be one function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59933
diff
changeset
|
1656 that place. If any of the functions returns non-@code{nil}, then the |
e568af229081
(Margins): fill-nobreak-predicate can be one function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59933
diff
changeset
|
1657 line won't be broken there. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1658 @end defvar |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1659 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1660 @node Adaptive Fill |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1661 @section Adaptive Fill Mode |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1662 @cindex Adaptive Fill mode |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1663 |
63316
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1664 When @dfn{Adaptive Fill Mode} is enabled, Emacs determines the fill |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1665 prefix automatically from the text in each paragraph being filled |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1666 rather than using a predetermined value. During filling, this fill |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1667 prefix gets inserted at the start of the second and subsequent lines |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1668 of the paragraph as described in @ref{Filling}, and in @ref{Auto |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1669 Filling}. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1670 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1671 @defopt adaptive-fill-mode |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1672 Adaptive Fill mode is enabled when this variable is non-@code{nil}. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1673 It is @code{t} by default. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1674 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1675 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1676 @defun fill-context-prefix from to |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1677 This function implements the heart of Adaptive Fill mode; it chooses a |
63316
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1678 fill prefix based on the text between @var{from} and @var{to}, |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1679 typically the start and end of a paragraph. It does this by looking |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1680 at the first two lines of the paragraph, based on the variables |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1681 described below. |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1682 @c The optional argument first-line-regexp is not documented |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1683 @c because it exists for internal purposes and might be eliminated |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1684 @c in the future. |
63316
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1685 |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1686 Usually, this function returns the fill prefix, a string. However, |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1687 before doing this, the function makes a final check (not specially |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1688 mentioned in the following) that a line starting with this prefix |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1689 wouldn't look like the start of a paragraph. Should this happen, the |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1690 function signals the anomaly by returning @code{nil} instead. |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1691 |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1692 In detail, @code{fill-context-prefix} does this: |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1693 |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1694 @enumerate |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1695 @item |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1696 It takes a candidate for the fill prefix from the first line---it |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1697 tries first the function in @code{adaptive-fill-function} (if any), |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1698 then the regular expression @code{adaptive-fill-regexp} (see below). |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1699 The first non-@code{nil} result of these, or the empty string if |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1700 they're both @code{nil}, becomes the first line's candidate. |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1701 @item |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1702 If the paragraph has as yet only one line, the function tests the |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1703 validity of the prefix candidate just found. The function then |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1704 returns the candidate if it's valid, or a string of spaces otherwise. |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1705 (see the description of @code{adaptive-fill-first-line-regexp} below). |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1706 @item |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1707 When the paragraph already has two lines, the function next looks for |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1708 a prefix candidate on the second line, in just the same way it did for |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1709 the first line. If it doesn't find one, it returns @code{nil}. |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1710 @item |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1711 The function now compares the two candidate prefixes heuristically: if |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1712 the non-whitespace characters in the line 2 candidate occur in the |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1713 same order in the line 1 candidate, the function returns the line 2 |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1714 candidate. Otherwise, it returns the largest initial substring which |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1715 is common to both candidates (which might be the empty string). |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1716 @end enumerate |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1717 @end defun |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1718 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1719 @defopt adaptive-fill-regexp |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1720 Adaptive Fill mode matches this regular expression against the text |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1721 starting after the left margin whitespace (if any) on a line; the |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1722 characters it matches are that line's candidate for the fill prefix. |
63316
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1723 |
69419
e043e733d1f5
(Adaptive Fill): Fix Texinfo usage.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
68648
diff
changeset
|
1724 @w{@code{"[ \t]*\\([-|#;>*]+[ \t]*\\|(?[0-9]+[.)][ \t]*\\)*"}} is the |
63583
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1725 default value. This matches a number enclosed in parentheses or |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1726 followed by a period, or certain punctuation characters, or any |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1727 sequence of these intermingled with whitespace. In particular, it |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
1728 matches a sequence of whitespace, possibly empty. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1729 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1730 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1731 @defopt adaptive-fill-first-line-regexp |
63316
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1732 Used only in one-line paragraphs, this regular expression acts as an |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1733 additional check of the validity of the one available candidate fill |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1734 prefix: the candidate must match this regular expression, or match |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1735 @code{comment-start-skip}. If it doesn't, @code{fill-context-prefix} |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1736 replaces the candidate with a string of spaces ``of the same width'' |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1737 as it. |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1738 |
69419
e043e733d1f5
(Adaptive Fill): Fix Texinfo usage.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
68648
diff
changeset
|
1739 The default value of this variable is @w{@code{"\\`[ \t]*\\'"}}, which |
63316
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1740 matches only a string of whitespace. The effect of this default is to |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1741 force the fill prefixes found in one-line paragraphs always to be pure |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1742 whitespace. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1743 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1744 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1745 @defopt adaptive-fill-function |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1746 You can specify more complex ways of choosing a fill prefix |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1747 automatically by setting this variable to a function. The function is |
63316
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1748 called with point after the left margin (if any) of a line, and it |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1749 must preserve point. It should return either ``that line's'' fill |
4697645d9edc
(Adaptive Fill): Amplify the description of fill-context-prefix.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
61116
diff
changeset
|
1750 prefix or @code{nil}, meaning it has failed to determine a prefix. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1751 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1752 |
6558 | 1753 @node Auto Filling |
1754 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1755 @section Auto Filling | |
1756 @cindex filling, automatic | |
1757 @cindex Auto Fill mode | |
1758 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1759 Auto Fill mode is a minor mode that fills lines automatically as text |
12282
586e3ea81792
updates for version 19.29 made by melissa; also needed to check out files
Melissa Weisshaus <melissa@gnu.org>
parents:
12098
diff
changeset
|
1760 is inserted. This section describes the hook used by Auto Fill mode. |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1761 For a description of functions that you can call explicitly to fill and |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1762 justify existing text, see @ref{Filling}. |
6558 | 1763 |
12098 | 1764 Auto Fill mode also enables the functions that change the margins and |
1765 justification style to refill portions of the text. @xref{Margins}. | |
1766 | |
6558 | 1767 @defvar auto-fill-function |
65369
822218f80ae4
2005-09-08 Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
65322
diff
changeset
|
1768 The value of this buffer-local variable should be a function (of no |
822218f80ae4
2005-09-08 Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
65322
diff
changeset
|
1769 arguments) to be called after self-inserting a character from the table |
28843 | 1770 @code{auto-fill-chars}. It may be @code{nil}, in which case nothing |
1771 special is done in that case. | |
6558 | 1772 |
1773 The value of @code{auto-fill-function} is @code{do-auto-fill} when | |
1774 Auto-Fill mode is enabled. That is a function whose sole purpose is to | |
1775 implement the usual strategy for breaking a line. | |
1776 | |
1777 @quotation | |
1778 In older Emacs versions, this variable was named @code{auto-fill-hook}, | |
1779 but since it is not called with the standard convention for hooks, it | |
1780 was renamed to @code{auto-fill-function} in version 19. | |
1781 @end quotation | |
1782 @end defvar | |
1783 | |
16702
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1784 @defvar normal-auto-fill-function |
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1785 This variable specifies the function to use for |
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1786 @code{auto-fill-function}, if and when Auto Fill is turned on. Major |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1787 modes can set buffer-local values for this variable to alter how Auto |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1788 Fill works. |
16702
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1789 @end defvar |
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1790 |
28843 | 1791 @defvar auto-fill-chars |
1792 A char table of characters which invoke @code{auto-fill-function} when | |
1793 self-inserted---space and newline in most language environments. They | |
1794 have an entry @code{t} in the table. | |
1795 @end defvar | |
1796 | |
6558 | 1797 @node Sorting |
1798 @section Sorting Text | |
1799 @cindex sorting text | |
1800 | |
1801 The sorting functions described in this section all rearrange text in | |
1802 a buffer. This is in contrast to the function @code{sort}, which | |
1803 rearranges the order of the elements of a list (@pxref{Rearrangement}). | |
1804 The values returned by these functions are not meaningful. | |
1805 | |
67769
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1806 @defun sort-subr reverse nextrecfun endrecfun &optional startkeyfun endkeyfun predicate |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1807 This function is the general text-sorting routine that subdivides a |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1808 buffer into records and then sorts them. Most of the commands in this |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1809 section use this function. |
6558 | 1810 |
1811 To understand how @code{sort-subr} works, consider the whole accessible | |
1812 portion of the buffer as being divided into disjoint pieces called | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1813 @dfn{sort records}. The records may or may not be contiguous, but they |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1814 must not overlap. A portion of each sort record (perhaps all of it) is |
6558 | 1815 designated as the sort key. Sorting rearranges the records in order by |
1816 their sort keys. | |
1817 | |
1818 Usually, the records are rearranged in order of ascending sort key. | |
1819 If the first argument to the @code{sort-subr} function, @var{reverse}, | |
1820 is non-@code{nil}, the sort records are rearranged in order of | |
1821 descending sort key. | |
1822 | |
1823 The next four arguments to @code{sort-subr} are functions that are | |
1824 called to move point across a sort record. They are called many times | |
1825 from within @code{sort-subr}. | |
1826 | |
1827 @enumerate | |
1828 @item | |
1829 @var{nextrecfun} is called with point at the end of a record. This | |
1830 function moves point to the start of the next record. The first record | |
1831 is assumed to start at the position of point when @code{sort-subr} is | |
1832 called. Therefore, you should usually move point to the beginning of | |
1833 the buffer before calling @code{sort-subr}. | |
1834 | |
1835 This function can indicate there are no more sort records by leaving | |
1836 point at the end of the buffer. | |
1837 | |
1838 @item | |
1839 @var{endrecfun} is called with point within a record. It moves point to | |
1840 the end of the record. | |
1841 | |
1842 @item | |
1843 @var{startkeyfun} is called to move point from the start of a record to | |
1844 the start of the sort key. This argument is optional; if it is omitted, | |
1845 the whole record is the sort key. If supplied, the function should | |
1846 either return a non-@code{nil} value to be used as the sort key, or | |
1847 return @code{nil} to indicate that the sort key is in the buffer | |
1848 starting at point. In the latter case, @var{endkeyfun} is called to | |
1849 find the end of the sort key. | |
1850 | |
1851 @item | |
1852 @var{endkeyfun} is called to move point from the start of the sort key | |
1853 to the end of the sort key. This argument is optional. If | |
1854 @var{startkeyfun} returns @code{nil} and this argument is omitted (or | |
1855 @code{nil}), then the sort key extends to the end of the record. There | |
1856 is no need for @var{endkeyfun} if @var{startkeyfun} returns a | |
1857 non-@code{nil} value. | |
1858 @end enumerate | |
1859 | |
67769
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1860 The argument @var{predicate} is the function to use to compare keys. |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1861 If keys are numbers, it defaults to @code{<}; otherwise it defaults to |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1862 @code{string<}. |
20a39d204662
(Undo): Restore some explanation from the version that was deleted.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67763
diff
changeset
|
1863 |
6558 | 1864 As an example of @code{sort-subr}, here is the complete function |
1865 definition for @code{sort-lines}: | |
1866 | |
1867 @example | |
1868 @group | |
1869 ;; @r{Note that the first two lines of doc string} | |
1870 ;; @r{are effectively one line when viewed by a user.} | |
1871 (defun sort-lines (reverse beg end) | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1872 "Sort lines in region alphabetically;\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1873 argument means descending order. |
6558 | 1874 Called from a program, there are three arguments: |
1875 @end group | |
1876 @group | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1877 REVERSE (non-nil means reverse order),\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1878 BEG and END (region to sort). |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1879 The variable `sort-fold-case' determines\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1880 whether alphabetic case affects |
54480
8c72fab9eb5a
(Sorting): Add missing quote.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents:
54120
diff
changeset
|
1881 the sort order." |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1882 @end group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1883 @group |
6558 | 1884 (interactive "P\nr") |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1885 (save-excursion |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1886 (save-restriction |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1887 (narrow-to-region beg end) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1888 (goto-char (point-min)) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1889 (sort-subr reverse 'forward-line 'end-of-line)))) |
6558 | 1890 @end group |
1891 @end example | |
1892 | |
1893 Here @code{forward-line} moves point to the start of the next record, | |
1894 and @code{end-of-line} moves point to the end of record. We do not pass | |
1895 the arguments @var{startkeyfun} and @var{endkeyfun}, because the entire | |
1896 record is used as the sort key. | |
1897 | |
1898 The @code{sort-paragraphs} function is very much the same, except that | |
1899 its @code{sort-subr} call looks like this: | |
1900 | |
1901 @example | |
1902 @group | |
1903 (sort-subr reverse | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1904 (function |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1905 (lambda () |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1906 (while (and (not (eobp)) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1907 (looking-at paragraph-separate)) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1908 (forward-line 1)))) |
6558 | 1909 'forward-paragraph) |
1910 @end group | |
1911 @end example | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1912 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1913 Markers pointing into any sort records are left with no useful |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1914 position after @code{sort-subr} returns. |
6558 | 1915 @end defun |
1916 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1917 @defopt sort-fold-case |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1918 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, @code{sort-subr} and the other |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1919 buffer sorting functions ignore case when comparing strings. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1920 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1921 |
6558 | 1922 @deffn Command sort-regexp-fields reverse record-regexp key-regexp start end |
1923 This command sorts the region between @var{start} and @var{end} | |
1924 alphabetically as specified by @var{record-regexp} and @var{key-regexp}. | |
1925 If @var{reverse} is a negative integer, then sorting is in reverse | |
1926 order. | |
1927 | |
1928 Alphabetical sorting means that two sort keys are compared by | |
1929 comparing the first characters of each, the second characters of each, | |
1930 and so on. If a mismatch is found, it means that the sort keys are | |
1931 unequal; the sort key whose character is less at the point of first | |
1932 mismatch is the lesser sort key. The individual characters are compared | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1933 according to their numerical character codes in the Emacs character set. |
6558 | 1934 |
1935 The value of the @var{record-regexp} argument specifies how to divide | |
1936 the buffer into sort records. At the end of each record, a search is | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1937 done for this regular expression, and the text that matches it is taken |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1938 as the next record. For example, the regular expression @samp{^.+$}, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1939 which matches lines with at least one character besides a newline, would |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1940 make each such line into a sort record. @xref{Regular Expressions}, for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1941 a description of the syntax and meaning of regular expressions. |
6558 | 1942 |
1943 The value of the @var{key-regexp} argument specifies what part of each | |
1944 record is the sort key. The @var{key-regexp} could match the whole | |
1945 record, or only a part. In the latter case, the rest of the record has | |
1946 no effect on the sorted order of records, but it is carried along when | |
1947 the record moves to its new position. | |
1948 | |
1949 The @var{key-regexp} argument can refer to the text matched by a | |
1950 subexpression of @var{record-regexp}, or it can be a regular expression | |
1951 on its own. | |
1952 | |
1953 If @var{key-regexp} is: | |
1954 | |
1955 @table @asis | |
1956 @item @samp{\@var{digit}} | |
1957 then the text matched by the @var{digit}th @samp{\(...\)} parenthesis | |
1958 grouping in @var{record-regexp} is the sort key. | |
1959 | |
1960 @item @samp{\&} | |
1961 then the whole record is the sort key. | |
1962 | |
1963 @item a regular expression | |
1964 then @code{sort-regexp-fields} searches for a match for the regular | |
1965 expression within the record. If such a match is found, it is the sort | |
1966 key. If there is no match for @var{key-regexp} within a record then | |
1967 that record is ignored, which means its position in the buffer is not | |
1968 changed. (The other records may move around it.) | |
1969 @end table | |
1970 | |
1971 For example, if you plan to sort all the lines in the region by the | |
1972 first word on each line starting with the letter @samp{f}, you should | |
1973 set @var{record-regexp} to @samp{^.*$} and set @var{key-regexp} to | |
1974 @samp{\<f\w*\>}. The resulting expression looks like this: | |
1975 | |
1976 @example | |
1977 @group | |
1978 (sort-regexp-fields nil "^.*$" "\\<f\\w*\\>" | |
1979 (region-beginning) | |
1980 (region-end)) | |
1981 @end group | |
1982 @end example | |
1983 | |
1984 If you call @code{sort-regexp-fields} interactively, it prompts for | |
1985 @var{record-regexp} and @var{key-regexp} in the minibuffer. | |
1986 @end deffn | |
1987 | |
1988 @deffn Command sort-lines reverse start end | |
1989 This command alphabetically sorts lines in the region between | |
1990 @var{start} and @var{end}. If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort | |
1991 is in reverse order. | |
1992 @end deffn | |
1993 | |
1994 @deffn Command sort-paragraphs reverse start end | |
1995 This command alphabetically sorts paragraphs in the region between | |
1996 @var{start} and @var{end}. If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort | |
1997 is in reverse order. | |
1998 @end deffn | |
1999 | |
2000 @deffn Command sort-pages reverse start end | |
2001 This command alphabetically sorts pages in the region between | |
2002 @var{start} and @var{end}. If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort | |
2003 is in reverse order. | |
2004 @end deffn | |
2005 | |
2006 @deffn Command sort-fields field start end | |
2007 This command sorts lines in the region between @var{start} and | |
2008 @var{end}, comparing them alphabetically by the @var{field}th field | |
2009 of each line. Fields are separated by whitespace and numbered starting | |
2010 from 1. If @var{field} is negative, sorting is by the | |
2011 @w{@minus{}@var{field}th} field from the end of the line. This command | |
2012 is useful for sorting tables. | |
2013 @end deffn | |
2014 | |
2015 @deffn Command sort-numeric-fields field start end | |
2016 This command sorts lines in the region between @var{start} and | |
59880
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2017 @var{end}, comparing them numerically by the @var{field}th field of |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2018 each line. Fields are separated by whitespace and numbered starting |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2019 from 1. The specified field must contain a number in each line of the |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2020 region. Numbers starting with 0 are treated as octal, and numbers |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2021 starting with @samp{0x} are treated as hexadecimal. |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2022 |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2023 If @var{field} is negative, sorting is by the |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2024 @w{@minus{}@var{field}th} field from the end of the line. This |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2025 command is useful for sorting tables. |
6558 | 2026 @end deffn |
2027 | |
59880
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2028 @defopt sort-numeric-base |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2029 This variable specifies the default radix for |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2030 @code{sort-numeric-fields} to parse numbers. |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2031 @end defopt |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2032 |
6558 | 2033 @deffn Command sort-columns reverse &optional beg end |
2034 This command sorts the lines in the region between @var{beg} and | |
59880
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2035 @var{end}, comparing them alphabetically by a certain range of |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2036 columns. The column positions of @var{beg} and @var{end} bound the |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
2037 range of columns to sort on. |
6558 | 2038 |
2039 If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort is in reverse order. | |
2040 | |
2041 One unusual thing about this command is that the entire line | |
2042 containing position @var{beg}, and the entire line containing position | |
2043 @var{end}, are included in the region sorted. | |
2044 | |
2045 Note that @code{sort-columns} uses the @code{sort} utility program, | |
2046 and so cannot work properly on text containing tab characters. Use | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2047 @kbd{M-x untabify} to convert tabs to spaces before sorting. |
6558 | 2048 @end deffn |
2049 | |
2050 @node Columns | |
2051 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
2052 @section Counting Columns | |
2053 @cindex columns | |
2054 @cindex counting columns | |
2055 @cindex horizontal position | |
2056 | |
2057 The column functions convert between a character position (counting | |
2058 characters from the beginning of the buffer) and a column position | |
2059 (counting screen characters from the beginning of a line). | |
2060 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2061 These functions count each character according to the number of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2062 columns it occupies on the screen. This means control characters count |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2063 as occupying 2 or 4 columns, depending upon the value of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2064 @code{ctl-arrow}, and tabs count as occupying a number of columns that |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2065 depends on the value of @code{tab-width} and on the column where the tab |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2066 begins. @xref{Usual Display}. |
6558 | 2067 |
2068 Column number computations ignore the width of the window and the | |
2069 amount of horizontal scrolling. Consequently, a column value can be | |
53435
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2070 arbitrarily high. The first (or leftmost) column is numbered 0. They |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2071 also ignore overlays and text properties, aside from invisibility. |
6558 | 2072 |
2073 @defun current-column | |
2074 This function returns the horizontal position of point, measured in | |
2075 columns, counting from 0 at the left margin. The column position is the | |
2076 sum of the widths of all the displayed representations of the characters | |
2077 between the start of the current line and point. | |
2078 | |
2079 For an example of using @code{current-column}, see the description of | |
2080 @code{count-lines} in @ref{Text Lines}. | |
2081 @end defun | |
2082 | |
2083 @defun move-to-column column &optional force | |
2084 This function moves point to @var{column} in the current line. The | |
2085 calculation of @var{column} takes into account the widths of the | |
2086 displayed representations of the characters between the start of the | |
2087 line and point. | |
2088 | |
2089 If column @var{column} is beyond the end of the line, point moves to the | |
2090 end of the line. If @var{column} is negative, point moves to the | |
2091 beginning of the line. | |
2092 | |
2093 If it is impossible to move to column @var{column} because that is in | |
2094 the middle of a multicolumn character such as a tab, point moves to the | |
2095 end of that character. However, if @var{force} is non-@code{nil}, and | |
2096 @var{column} is in the middle of a tab, then @code{move-to-column} | |
2097 converts the tab into spaces so that it can move precisely to column | |
2098 @var{column}. Other multicolumn characters can cause anomalies despite | |
2099 @var{force}, since there is no way to split them. | |
2100 | |
2101 The argument @var{force} also has an effect if the line isn't long | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2102 enough to reach column @var{column}; if it is @code{t}, that means to |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2103 add whitespace at the end of the line to reach that column. |
6558 | 2104 |
2105 If @var{column} is not an integer, an error is signaled. | |
2106 | |
2107 The return value is the column number actually moved to. | |
2108 @end defun | |
2109 | |
2110 @node Indentation | |
2111 @section Indentation | |
2112 @cindex indentation | |
2113 | |
2114 The indentation functions are used to examine, move to, and change | |
2115 whitespace that is at the beginning of a line. Some of the functions | |
2116 can also change whitespace elsewhere on a line. Columns and indentation | |
2117 count from zero at the left margin. | |
2118 | |
2119 @menu | |
2120 * Primitive Indent:: Functions used to count and insert indentation. | |
2121 * Mode-Specific Indent:: Customize indentation for different modes. | |
2122 * Region Indent:: Indent all the lines in a region. | |
2123 * Relative Indent:: Indent the current line based on previous lines. | |
2124 * Indent Tabs:: Adjustable, typewriter-like tab stops. | |
2125 * Motion by Indent:: Move to first non-blank character. | |
2126 @end menu | |
2127 | |
2128 @node Primitive Indent | |
2129 @subsection Indentation Primitives | |
2130 | |
2131 This section describes the primitive functions used to count and | |
2132 insert indentation. The functions in the following sections use these | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2133 primitives. @xref{Width}, for related functions. |
6558 | 2134 |
2135 @defun current-indentation | |
2136 @comment !!Type Primitive Function | |
2137 @comment !!SourceFile indent.c | |
2138 This function returns the indentation of the current line, which is | |
2139 the horizontal position of the first nonblank character. If the | |
2140 contents are entirely blank, then this is the horizontal position of the | |
2141 end of the line. | |
2142 @end defun | |
2143 | |
2144 @deffn Command indent-to column &optional minimum | |
2145 @comment !!Type Primitive Function | |
2146 @comment !!SourceFile indent.c | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2147 This function indents from point with tabs and spaces until @var{column} |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2148 is reached. If @var{minimum} is specified and non-@code{nil}, then at |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2149 least that many spaces are inserted even if this requires going beyond |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2150 @var{column}. Otherwise the function does nothing if point is already |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2151 beyond @var{column}. The value is the column at which the inserted |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2152 indentation ends. |
8644 | 2153 |
2154 The inserted whitespace characters inherit text properties from the | |
2155 surrounding text (usually, from the preceding text only). @xref{Sticky | |
2156 Properties}. | |
6558 | 2157 @end deffn |
2158 | |
2159 @defopt indent-tabs-mode | |
2160 @comment !!SourceFile indent.c | |
2161 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, indentation functions can insert | |
2162 tabs as well as spaces. Otherwise, they insert only spaces. Setting | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2163 this variable automatically makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
6558 | 2164 @end defopt |
2165 | |
2166 @node Mode-Specific Indent | |
2167 @subsection Indentation Controlled by Major Mode | |
2168 | |
2169 An important function of each major mode is to customize the @key{TAB} | |
2170 key to indent properly for the language being edited. This section | |
2171 describes the mechanism of the @key{TAB} key and how to control it. | |
2172 The functions in this section return unpredictable values. | |
2173 | |
2174 @defvar indent-line-function | |
2175 This variable's value is the function to be used by @key{TAB} (and | |
2176 various commands) to indent the current line. The command | |
2177 @code{indent-according-to-mode} does no more than call this function. | |
2178 | |
2179 In Lisp mode, the value is the symbol @code{lisp-indent-line}; in C | |
2180 mode, @code{c-indent-line}; in Fortran mode, @code{fortran-indent-line}. | |
2181 In Fundamental mode, Text mode, and many other modes with no standard | |
2182 for indentation, the value is @code{indent-to-left-margin} (which is the | |
2183 default value). | |
2184 @end defvar | |
2185 | |
2186 @deffn Command indent-according-to-mode | |
2187 This command calls the function in @code{indent-line-function} to | |
2188 indent the current line in a way appropriate for the current major mode. | |
2189 @end deffn | |
2190 | |
2191 @deffn Command indent-for-tab-command | |
2192 This command calls the function in @code{indent-line-function} to indent | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2193 the current line; however, if that function is |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2194 @code{indent-to-left-margin}, @code{insert-tab} is called instead. (That |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2195 is a trivial command that inserts a tab character.) |
6558 | 2196 @end deffn |
2197 | |
2198 @deffn Command newline-and-indent | |
2199 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
2200 This function inserts a newline, then indents the new line (the one | |
2201 following the newline just inserted) according to the major mode. | |
2202 | |
2203 It does indentation by calling the current @code{indent-line-function}. | |
2204 In programming language modes, this is the same thing @key{TAB} does, | |
2205 but in some text modes, where @key{TAB} inserts a tab, | |
2206 @code{newline-and-indent} indents to the column specified by | |
2207 @code{left-margin}. | |
2208 @end deffn | |
2209 | |
2210 @deffn Command reindent-then-newline-and-indent | |
2211 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
2212 This command reindents the current line, inserts a newline at point, | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
2213 and then indents the new line (the one following the newline just |
6558 | 2214 inserted). |
2215 | |
2216 This command does indentation on both lines according to the current | |
2217 major mode, by calling the current value of @code{indent-line-function}. | |
2218 In programming language modes, this is the same thing @key{TAB} does, | |
2219 but in some text modes, where @key{TAB} inserts a tab, | |
2220 @code{reindent-then-newline-and-indent} indents to the column specified | |
2221 by @code{left-margin}. | |
2222 @end deffn | |
2223 | |
2224 @node Region Indent | |
2225 @subsection Indenting an Entire Region | |
2226 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2227 This section describes commands that indent all the lines in the |
6558 | 2228 region. They return unpredictable values. |
2229 | |
2230 @deffn Command indent-region start end to-column | |
2231 This command indents each nonblank line starting between @var{start} | |
2232 (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive). If @var{to-column} is | |
2233 @code{nil}, @code{indent-region} indents each nonblank line by calling | |
2234 the current mode's indentation function, the value of | |
2235 @code{indent-line-function}. | |
2236 | |
2237 If @var{to-column} is non-@code{nil}, it should be an integer | |
2238 specifying the number of columns of indentation; then this function | |
2239 gives each line exactly that much indentation, by either adding or | |
2240 deleting whitespace. | |
2241 | |
2242 If there is a fill prefix, @code{indent-region} indents each line | |
2243 by making it start with the fill prefix. | |
2244 @end deffn | |
2245 | |
2246 @defvar indent-region-function | |
2247 The value of this variable is a function that can be used by | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2248 @code{indent-region} as a short cut. It should take two arguments, the |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2249 start and end of the region. You should design the function so |
6558 | 2250 that it will produce the same results as indenting the lines of the |
2251 region one by one, but presumably faster. | |
2252 | |
2253 If the value is @code{nil}, there is no short cut, and | |
2254 @code{indent-region} actually works line by line. | |
2255 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2256 A short-cut function is useful in modes such as C mode and Lisp mode, |
6558 | 2257 where the @code{indent-line-function} must scan from the beginning of |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2258 the function definition: applying it to each line would be quadratic in |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2259 time. The short cut can update the scan information as it moves through |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2260 the lines indenting them; this takes linear time. In a mode where |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2261 indenting a line individually is fast, there is no need for a short cut. |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2262 |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2263 @code{indent-region} with a non-@code{nil} argument @var{to-column} has |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2264 a different meaning and does not use this variable. |
6558 | 2265 @end defvar |
2266 | |
2267 @deffn Command indent-rigidly start end count | |
2268 @comment !!SourceFile indent.el | |
2269 This command indents all lines starting between @var{start} | |
2270 (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive) sideways by @var{count} columns. | |
2271 This ``preserves the shape'' of the affected region, moving it as a | |
2272 rigid unit. Consequently, this command is useful not only for indenting | |
2273 regions of unindented text, but also for indenting regions of formatted | |
2274 code. | |
2275 | |
2276 For example, if @var{count} is 3, this command adds 3 columns of | |
2277 indentation to each of the lines beginning in the region specified. | |
2278 | |
2279 In Mail mode, @kbd{C-c C-y} (@code{mail-yank-original}) uses | |
2280 @code{indent-rigidly} to indent the text copied from the message being | |
2281 replied to. | |
2282 @end deffn | |
2283 | |
2284 @defun indent-code-rigidly start end columns &optional nochange-regexp | |
2285 This is like @code{indent-rigidly}, except that it doesn't alter lines | |
2286 that start within strings or comments. | |
2287 | |
2288 In addition, it doesn't alter a line if @var{nochange-regexp} matches at | |
2289 the beginning of the line (if @var{nochange-regexp} is non-@code{nil}). | |
2290 @end defun | |
2291 | |
2292 @node Relative Indent | |
2293 @subsection Indentation Relative to Previous Lines | |
2294 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2295 This section describes two commands that indent the current line |
6558 | 2296 based on the contents of previous lines. |
2297 | |
2298 @deffn Command indent-relative &optional unindented-ok | |
2299 This command inserts whitespace at point, extending to the same | |
2300 column as the next @dfn{indent point} of the previous nonblank line. An | |
2301 indent point is a non-whitespace character following whitespace. The | |
2302 next indent point is the first one at a column greater than the current | |
2303 column of point. For example, if point is underneath and to the left of | |
2304 the first non-blank character of a line of text, it moves to that column | |
2305 by inserting whitespace. | |
2306 | |
2307 If the previous nonblank line has no next indent point (i.e., none at a | |
2308 great enough column position), @code{indent-relative} either does | |
2309 nothing (if @var{unindented-ok} is non-@code{nil}) or calls | |
2310 @code{tab-to-tab-stop}. Thus, if point is underneath and to the right | |
2311 of the last column of a short line of text, this command ordinarily | |
2312 moves point to the next tab stop by inserting whitespace. | |
2313 | |
2314 The return value of @code{indent-relative} is unpredictable. | |
2315 | |
2316 In the following example, point is at the beginning of the second | |
2317 line: | |
2318 | |
2319 @example | |
2320 @group | |
2321 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2322 @point{}The quick brown fox jumped. | |
2323 @end group | |
2324 @end example | |
2325 | |
2326 @noindent | |
2327 Evaluation of the expression @code{(indent-relative nil)} produces the | |
2328 following: | |
2329 | |
2330 @example | |
2331 @group | |
2332 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2333 @point{}The quick brown fox jumped. | |
2334 @end group | |
2335 @end example | |
2336 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2337 In this next example, point is between the @samp{m} and @samp{p} of |
6558 | 2338 @samp{jumped}: |
2339 | |
2340 @example | |
2341 @group | |
2342 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2343 The quick brown fox jum@point{}ped. | |
2344 @end group | |
2345 @end example | |
2346 | |
2347 @noindent | |
2348 Evaluation of the expression @code{(indent-relative nil)} produces the | |
2349 following: | |
2350 | |
2351 @example | |
2352 @group | |
2353 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2354 The quick brown fox jum @point{}ped. | |
2355 @end group | |
2356 @end example | |
2357 @end deffn | |
2358 | |
2359 @deffn Command indent-relative-maybe | |
2360 @comment !!SourceFile indent.el | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2361 This command indents the current line like the previous nonblank line, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2362 by calling @code{indent-relative} with @code{t} as the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2363 @var{unindented-ok} argument. The return value is unpredictable. |
6558 | 2364 |
2365 If the previous nonblank line has no indent points beyond the current | |
2366 column, this command does nothing. | |
2367 @end deffn | |
2368 | |
2369 @node Indent Tabs | |
2370 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
2371 @subsection Adjustable ``Tab Stops'' | |
2372 @cindex tabs stops for indentation | |
2373 | |
2374 This section explains the mechanism for user-specified ``tab stops'' | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2375 and the mechanisms that use and set them. The name ``tab stops'' is |
6558 | 2376 used because the feature is similar to that of the tab stops on a |
2377 typewriter. The feature works by inserting an appropriate number of | |
2378 spaces and tab characters to reach the next tab stop column; it does not | |
2379 affect the display of tab characters in the buffer (@pxref{Usual | |
2380 Display}). Note that the @key{TAB} character as input uses this tab | |
2381 stop feature only in a few major modes, such as Text mode. | |
2382 | |
2383 @deffn Command tab-to-tab-stop | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2384 This command inserts spaces or tabs before point, up to the next tab |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2385 stop column defined by @code{tab-stop-list}. It searches the list for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2386 an element greater than the current column number, and uses that element |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2387 as the column to indent to. It does nothing if no such element is |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2388 found. |
6558 | 2389 @end deffn |
2390 | |
2391 @defopt tab-stop-list | |
2392 This variable is the list of tab stop columns used by | |
2393 @code{tab-to-tab-stops}. The elements should be integers in increasing | |
2394 order. The tab stop columns need not be evenly spaced. | |
2395 | |
2396 Use @kbd{M-x edit-tab-stops} to edit the location of tab stops | |
2397 interactively. | |
2398 @end defopt | |
2399 | |
2400 @node Motion by Indent | |
2401 @subsection Indentation-Based Motion Commands | |
2402 | |
2403 These commands, primarily for interactive use, act based on the | |
2404 indentation in the text. | |
2405 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
2406 @deffn Command back-to-indentation |
6558 | 2407 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el |
2408 This command moves point to the first non-whitespace character in the | |
2409 current line (which is the line in which point is located). It returns | |
2410 @code{nil}. | |
2411 @end deffn | |
2412 | |
52544
5e831368522d
(Motion by Indent): Arg to backward-to-indentation and
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2413 @deffn Command backward-to-indentation &optional arg |
6558 | 2414 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el |
2415 This command moves point backward @var{arg} lines and then to the | |
2416 first nonblank character on that line. It returns @code{nil}. | |
52544
5e831368522d
(Motion by Indent): Arg to backward-to-indentation and
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2417 If @var{arg} is omitted or @code{nil}, it defaults to 1. |
6558 | 2418 @end deffn |
2419 | |
52544
5e831368522d
(Motion by Indent): Arg to backward-to-indentation and
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2420 @deffn Command forward-to-indentation &optional arg |
6558 | 2421 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el |
2422 This command moves point forward @var{arg} lines and then to the first | |
2423 nonblank character on that line. It returns @code{nil}. | |
52544
5e831368522d
(Motion by Indent): Arg to backward-to-indentation and
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2424 If @var{arg} is omitted or @code{nil}, it defaults to 1. |
6558 | 2425 @end deffn |
2426 | |
2427 @node Case Changes | |
2428 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
2429 @section Case Changes | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2430 @cindex case conversion in buffers |
6558 | 2431 |
2432 The case change commands described here work on text in the current | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2433 buffer. @xref{Case Conversion}, for case conversion functions that work |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2434 on strings and characters. @xref{Case Tables}, for how to customize |
6558 | 2435 which characters are upper or lower case and how to convert them. |
2436 | |
2437 @deffn Command capitalize-region start end | |
2438 This function capitalizes all words in the region defined by | |
2439 @var{start} and @var{end}. To capitalize means to convert each word's | |
2440 first character to upper case and convert the rest of each word to lower | |
2441 case. The function returns @code{nil}. | |
2442 | |
2443 If one end of the region is in the middle of a word, the part of the | |
2444 word within the region is treated as an entire word. | |
2445 | |
2446 When @code{capitalize-region} is called interactively, @var{start} and | |
2447 @var{end} are point and the mark, with the smallest first. | |
2448 | |
2449 @example | |
2450 @group | |
2451 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2452 This is the contents of the 5th foo. | |
2453 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2454 @end group | |
2455 | |
2456 @group | |
2457 (capitalize-region 1 44) | |
2458 @result{} nil | |
2459 | |
2460 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2461 This Is The Contents Of The 5th Foo. | |
2462 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2463 @end group | |
2464 @end example | |
2465 @end deffn | |
2466 | |
2467 @deffn Command downcase-region start end | |
2468 This function converts all of the letters in the region defined by | |
2469 @var{start} and @var{end} to lower case. The function returns | |
2470 @code{nil}. | |
2471 | |
2472 When @code{downcase-region} is called interactively, @var{start} and | |
2473 @var{end} are point and the mark, with the smallest first. | |
2474 @end deffn | |
2475 | |
2476 @deffn Command upcase-region start end | |
2477 This function converts all of the letters in the region defined by | |
2478 @var{start} and @var{end} to upper case. The function returns | |
2479 @code{nil}. | |
2480 | |
2481 When @code{upcase-region} is called interactively, @var{start} and | |
2482 @var{end} are point and the mark, with the smallest first. | |
2483 @end deffn | |
2484 | |
2485 @deffn Command capitalize-word count | |
2486 This function capitalizes @var{count} words after point, moving point | |
2487 over as it does. To capitalize means to convert each word's first | |
2488 character to upper case and convert the rest of each word to lower case. | |
2489 If @var{count} is negative, the function capitalizes the | |
2490 @minus{}@var{count} previous words but does not move point. The value | |
2491 is @code{nil}. | |
2492 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2493 If point is in the middle of a word, the part of the word before point |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2494 is ignored when moving forward. The rest is treated as an entire word. |
6558 | 2495 |
2496 When @code{capitalize-word} is called interactively, @var{count} is | |
2497 set to the numeric prefix argument. | |
2498 @end deffn | |
2499 | |
2500 @deffn Command downcase-word count | |
2501 This function converts the @var{count} words after point to all lower | |
2502 case, moving point over as it does. If @var{count} is negative, it | |
2503 converts the @minus{}@var{count} previous words but does not move point. | |
2504 The value is @code{nil}. | |
2505 | |
2506 When @code{downcase-word} is called interactively, @var{count} is set | |
2507 to the numeric prefix argument. | |
2508 @end deffn | |
2509 | |
2510 @deffn Command upcase-word count | |
2511 This function converts the @var{count} words after point to all upper | |
2512 case, moving point over as it does. If @var{count} is negative, it | |
2513 converts the @minus{}@var{count} previous words but does not move point. | |
2514 The value is @code{nil}. | |
2515 | |
2516 When @code{upcase-word} is called interactively, @var{count} is set to | |
2517 the numeric prefix argument. | |
2518 @end deffn | |
2519 | |
2520 @node Text Properties | |
2521 @section Text Properties | |
2522 @cindex text properties | |
2523 @cindex attributes of text | |
2524 @cindex properties of text | |
2525 | |
2526 Each character position in a buffer or a string can have a @dfn{text | |
2527 property list}, much like the property list of a symbol (@pxref{Property | |
2528 Lists}). The properties belong to a particular character at a | |
2529 particular place, such as, the letter @samp{T} at the beginning of this | |
2530 sentence or the first @samp{o} in @samp{foo}---if the same character | |
2531 occurs in two different places, the two occurrences generally have | |
2532 different properties. | |
2533 | |
2534 Each property has a name and a value. Both of these can be any Lisp | |
2535 object, but the name is normally a symbol. The usual way to access the | |
2536 property list is to specify a name and ask what value corresponds to it. | |
2537 | |
2538 If a character has a @code{category} property, we call it the | |
2539 @dfn{category} of the character. It should be a symbol. The properties | |
2540 of the symbol serve as defaults for the properties of the character. | |
2541 | |
2542 Copying text between strings and buffers preserves the properties | |
2543 along with the characters; this includes such diverse functions as | |
2544 @code{substring}, @code{insert}, and @code{buffer-substring}. | |
2545 | |
2546 @menu | |
40588
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2547 * Examining Properties:: Looking at the properties of one character. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2548 * Changing Properties:: Setting the properties of a range of text. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2549 * Property Search:: Searching for where a property changes value. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2550 * Special Properties:: Particular properties with special meanings. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2551 * Format Properties:: Properties for representing formatting of text. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2552 * Sticky Properties:: How inserted text gets properties from |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2553 neighboring text. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2554 * Saving Properties:: Saving text properties in files, and reading |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2555 them back. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2556 * Lazy Properties:: Computing text properties in a lazy fashion |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2557 only when text is examined. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2558 * Clickable Text:: Using text properties to make regions of text |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2559 do something when you click on them. |
59504
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
2560 * Links and Mouse-1:: How to make @key{Mouse-1} follow a link. |
40588
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2561 * Fields:: The @code{field} property defines |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2562 fields within the buffer. |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2563 * Not Intervals:: Why text properties do not use |
86c8a6492402
Minor menu indentation cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39530
diff
changeset
|
2564 Lisp-visible text intervals. |
6558 | 2565 @end menu |
2566 | |
2567 @node Examining Properties | |
2568 @subsection Examining Text Properties | |
2569 | |
2570 The simplest way to examine text properties is to ask for the value of | |
2571 a particular property of a particular character. For that, use | |
2572 @code{get-text-property}. Use @code{text-properties-at} to get the | |
2573 entire property list of a character. @xref{Property Search}, for | |
2574 functions to examine the properties of a number of characters at once. | |
2575 | |
2576 These functions handle both strings and buffers. Keep in mind that | |
2577 positions in a string start from 0, whereas positions in a buffer start | |
2578 from 1. | |
2579 | |
2580 @defun get-text-property pos prop &optional object | |
2581 This function returns the value of the @var{prop} property of the | |
2582 character after position @var{pos} in @var{object} (a buffer or | |
2583 string). The argument @var{object} is optional and defaults to the | |
2584 current buffer. | |
2585 | |
2586 If there is no @var{prop} property strictly speaking, but the character | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2587 has a category that is a symbol, then @code{get-text-property} returns |
6558 | 2588 the @var{prop} property of that symbol. |
2589 @end defun | |
2590 | |
53435
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2591 @defun get-char-property position prop &optional object |
6558 | 2592 This function is like @code{get-text-property}, except that it checks |
2593 overlays first and then text properties. @xref{Overlays}. | |
2594 | |
2595 The argument @var{object} may be a string, a buffer, or a window. If it | |
2596 is a window, then the buffer displayed in that window is used for text | |
2597 properties and overlays, but only the overlays active for that window | |
2598 are considered. If @var{object} is a buffer, then all overlays in that | |
2599 buffer are considered, as well as text properties. If @var{object} is a | |
2600 string, only text properties are considered, since strings never have | |
2601 overlays. | |
2602 @end defun | |
2603 | |
53435
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2604 @defun get-char-property-and-overlay position prop &optional object |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2605 This is like @code{get-char-property}, but gives extra information |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2606 about the overlay that the property value comes from. |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2607 |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2608 Its value is a cons cell whose @sc{car} is the property value, the |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2609 same value @code{get-char-property} would return with the same |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2610 arguments. Its @sc{cdr} is the overlay in which the property was |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2611 found, or @code{nil}, if it was found as a text property or not found |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2612 at all. |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2613 |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2614 If @var{position} is at the end of @var{object}, both the @sc{car} and |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2615 the @sc{cdr} of the value are @code{nil}. |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2616 @end defun |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2617 |
45685
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2618 @defvar char-property-alias-alist |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2619 This variable holds an alist which maps property names to a list of |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2620 alternative property names. If a character does not specify a direct |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2621 value for a property, the alternative property names are consulted in |
51702
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
2622 order; the first non-@code{nil} value is used. This variable takes |
45685
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2623 precedence over @code{default-text-properties}, and @code{category} |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2624 properties take precedence over this variable. |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2625 @end defvar |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2626 |
6558 | 2627 @defun text-properties-at position &optional object |
2628 This function returns the entire property list of the character at | |
2629 @var{position} in the string or buffer @var{object}. If @var{object} is | |
2630 @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2631 @end defun | |
2632 | |
12067 | 2633 @defvar default-text-properties |
2634 This variable holds a property list giving default values for text | |
2635 properties. Whenever a character does not specify a value for a | |
45685
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2636 property, neither directly, through a category symbol, or through |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2637 @code{char-property-alias-alist}, the value stored in this list is |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2638 used instead. Here is an example: |
12067 | 2639 |
2640 @example | |
45685
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2641 (setq default-text-properties '(foo 69) |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2642 char-property-alias-alist nil) |
12067 | 2643 ;; @r{Make sure character 1 has no properties of its own.} |
2644 (set-text-properties 1 2 nil) | |
2645 ;; @r{What we get, when we ask, is the default value.} | |
2646 (get-text-property 1 'foo) | |
2647 @result{} 69 | |
2648 @end example | |
2649 @end defvar | |
2650 | |
6558 | 2651 @node Changing Properties |
2652 @subsection Changing Text Properties | |
2653 | |
2654 The primitives for changing properties apply to a specified range of | |
18339
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2655 text in a buffer or string. The function @code{set-text-properties} |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2656 (see end of section) sets the entire property list of the text in that |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2657 range; more often, it is useful to add, change, or delete just certain |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2658 properties specified by name. |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2659 |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2660 Since text properties are considered part of the contents of the |
49184
55666b1c590b
(Changing Properties): Say string indices are origin-0.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
47475
diff
changeset
|
2661 buffer (or string), and can affect how a buffer looks on the screen, |
55666b1c590b
(Changing Properties): Say string indices are origin-0.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
47475
diff
changeset
|
2662 any change in buffer text properties marks the buffer as modified. |
55666b1c590b
(Changing Properties): Say string indices are origin-0.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
47475
diff
changeset
|
2663 Buffer text property changes are undoable also (@pxref{Undo}). |
55666b1c590b
(Changing Properties): Say string indices are origin-0.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
47475
diff
changeset
|
2664 Positions in a string start from 0, whereas positions in a buffer |
55666b1c590b
(Changing Properties): Say string indices are origin-0.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
47475
diff
changeset
|
2665 start from 1. |
6558 | 2666 |
12098 | 2667 @defun put-text-property start end prop value &optional object |
2668 This function sets the @var{prop} property to @var{value} for the text | |
2669 between @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. | |
2670 If @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2671 @end defun | |
2672 | |
6558 | 2673 @defun add-text-properties start end props &optional object |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2674 This function adds or overrides text properties for the text between |
6558 | 2675 @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. If |
2676 @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2677 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2678 The argument @var{props} specifies which properties to add. It should |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2679 have the form of a property list (@pxref{Property Lists}): a list whose |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2680 elements include the property names followed alternately by the |
6558 | 2681 corresponding values. |
2682 | |
2683 The return value is @code{t} if the function actually changed some | |
2684 property's value; @code{nil} otherwise (if @var{props} is @code{nil} or | |
2685 its values agree with those in the text). | |
2686 | |
2687 For example, here is how to set the @code{comment} and @code{face} | |
2688 properties of a range of text: | |
2689 | |
2690 @example | |
2691 (add-text-properties @var{start} @var{end} | |
2692 '(comment t face highlight)) | |
2693 @end example | |
2694 @end defun | |
2695 | |
2696 @defun remove-text-properties start end props &optional object | |
2697 This function deletes specified text properties from the text between | |
2698 @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. If | |
2699 @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2700 | |
2701 The argument @var{props} specifies which properties to delete. It | |
2702 should have the form of a property list (@pxref{Property Lists}): a list | |
2703 whose elements are property names alternating with corresponding values. | |
2704 But only the names matter---the values that accompany them are ignored. | |
2705 For example, here's how to remove the @code{face} property. | |
2706 | |
2707 @example | |
2708 (remove-text-properties @var{start} @var{end} '(face nil)) | |
2709 @end example | |
2710 | |
2711 The return value is @code{t} if the function actually changed some | |
2712 property's value; @code{nil} otherwise (if @var{props} is @code{nil} or | |
2713 if no character in the specified text had any of those properties). | |
18339
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2714 |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2715 To remove all text properties from certain text, use |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2716 @code{set-text-properties} and specify @code{nil} for the new property |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2717 list. |
6558 | 2718 @end defun |
2719 | |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
2720 @defun remove-list-of-text-properties start end list-of-properties &optional object |
60679
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
2721 Like @code{remove-text-properties} except that |
68084 | 2722 @var{list-of-properties} is a list of property names only, not an |
60679
48eb1c71ba69
(Filling): Add sentence-end-without-period and sentence-end-without-space.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60456
diff
changeset
|
2723 alternating list of property names and values. |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
2724 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
2725 |
6558 | 2726 @defun set-text-properties start end props &optional object |
2727 This function completely replaces the text property list for the text | |
2728 between @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. | |
2729 If @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2730 | |
2731 The argument @var{props} is the new property list. It should be a list | |
2732 whose elements are property names alternating with corresponding values. | |
2733 | |
2734 After @code{set-text-properties} returns, all the characters in the | |
2735 specified range have identical properties. | |
2736 | |
2737 If @var{props} is @code{nil}, the effect is to get rid of all properties | |
2738 from the specified range of text. Here's an example: | |
2739 | |
2740 @example | |
2741 (set-text-properties @var{start} @var{end} nil) | |
2742 @end example | |
67930
58a64605ff5a
(Changing Properties): Don't use return value of set-text-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67769
diff
changeset
|
2743 |
58a64605ff5a
(Changing Properties): Don't use return value of set-text-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
67769
diff
changeset
|
2744 Do not rely on the return value of this function. |
6558 | 2745 @end defun |
2746 | |
25875 | 2747 The easiest way to make a string with text properties |
2748 is with @code{propertize}: | |
2749 | |
2750 @defun propertize string &rest properties | |
2751 @tindex propertize | |
2752 This function returns a copy of @var{string} which has the text | |
2753 properties @var{properties}. These properties apply to all the | |
2754 characters in the string that is returned. Here is an example that | |
2755 constructs a string with a @code{face} property and a @code{mouse-face} | |
2756 property: | |
2757 | |
2758 @smallexample | |
2759 (propertize "foo" 'face 'italic | |
2760 'mouse-face 'bold-italic) | |
2761 @result{} #("foo" 0 3 (mouse-face bold-italic face italic)) | |
2762 @end smallexample | |
2763 | |
2764 To put different properties on various parts of a string, you can | |
2765 construct each part with @code{propertize} and then combine them with | |
2766 @code{concat}: | |
2767 | |
2768 @smallexample | |
2769 (concat | |
2770 (propertize "foo" 'face 'italic | |
2771 'mouse-face 'bold-italic) | |
2772 " and " | |
2773 (propertize "bar" 'face 'italic | |
2774 'mouse-face 'bold-italic)) | |
2775 @result{} #("foo and bar" | |
2776 0 3 (face italic mouse-face bold-italic) | |
2777 3 8 nil | |
2778 8 11 (face italic mouse-face bold-italic)) | |
2779 @end smallexample | |
2780 @end defun | |
2781 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2782 See also the function @code{buffer-substring-no-properties} |
12067 | 2783 (@pxref{Buffer Contents}) which copies text from the buffer |
2784 but does not copy its properties. | |
2785 | |
6558 | 2786 @node Property Search |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2787 @subsection Text Property Search Functions |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2788 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2789 In typical use of text properties, most of the time several or many |
6558 | 2790 consecutive characters have the same value for a property. Rather than |
2791 writing your programs to examine characters one by one, it is much | |
2792 faster to process chunks of text that have the same property value. | |
2793 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2794 Here are functions you can use to do this. They use @code{eq} for |
12098 | 2795 comparing property values. In all cases, @var{object} defaults to the |
2796 current buffer. | |
6558 | 2797 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2798 For high performance, it's very important to use the @var{limit} |
6558 | 2799 argument to these functions, especially the ones that search for a |
12098 | 2800 single property---otherwise, they may spend a long time scanning to the |
2801 end of the buffer, if the property you are interested in does not change. | |
6558 | 2802 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2803 These functions do not move point; instead, they return a position (or |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2804 @code{nil}). Remember that a position is always between two characters; |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2805 the position returned by these functions is between two characters with |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2806 different properties. |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2807 |
6558 | 2808 @defun next-property-change pos &optional object limit |
2809 The function scans the text forward from position @var{pos} in the | |
2810 string or buffer @var{object} till it finds a change in some text | |
2811 property, then returns the position of the change. In other words, it | |
2812 returns the position of the first character beyond @var{pos} whose | |
2813 properties are not identical to those of the character just after | |
2814 @var{pos}. | |
2815 | |
2816 If @var{limit} is non-@code{nil}, then the scan ends at position | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
2817 @var{limit}. If there is no property change before that point, |
6558 | 2818 @code{next-property-change} returns @var{limit}. |
2819 | |
2820 The value is @code{nil} if the properties remain unchanged all the way | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2821 to the end of @var{object} and @var{limit} is @code{nil}. If the value |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2822 is non-@code{nil}, it is a position greater than or equal to @var{pos}. |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2823 The value equals @var{pos} only when @var{limit} equals @var{pos}. |
6558 | 2824 |
2825 Here is an example of how to scan the buffer by chunks of text within | |
2826 which all properties are constant: | |
2827 | |
2828 @smallexample | |
2829 (while (not (eobp)) | |
2830 (let ((plist (text-properties-at (point))) | |
2831 (next-change | |
2832 (or (next-property-change (point) (current-buffer)) | |
2833 (point-max)))) | |
2834 @r{Process text from point to @var{next-change}@dots{}} | |
2835 (goto-char next-change))) | |
2836 @end smallexample | |
2837 @end defun | |
2838 | |
2839 @defun next-single-property-change pos prop &optional object limit | |
2840 The function scans the text forward from position @var{pos} in the | |
2841 string or buffer @var{object} till it finds a change in the @var{prop} | |
2842 property, then returns the position of the change. In other words, it | |
2843 returns the position of the first character beyond @var{pos} whose | |
2844 @var{prop} property differs from that of the character just after | |
2845 @var{pos}. | |
2846 | |
2847 If @var{limit} is non-@code{nil}, then the scan ends at position | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
2848 @var{limit}. If there is no property change before that point, |
6558 | 2849 @code{next-single-property-change} returns @var{limit}. |
2850 | |
2851 The value is @code{nil} if the property remains unchanged all the way to | |
2852 the end of @var{object} and @var{limit} is @code{nil}. If the value is | |
2853 non-@code{nil}, it is a position greater than or equal to @var{pos}; it | |
2854 equals @var{pos} only if @var{limit} equals @var{pos}. | |
2855 @end defun | |
2856 | |
2857 @defun previous-property-change pos &optional object limit | |
2858 This is like @code{next-property-change}, but scans back from @var{pos} | |
2859 instead of forward. If the value is non-@code{nil}, it is a position | |
2860 less than or equal to @var{pos}; it equals @var{pos} only if @var{limit} | |
2861 equals @var{pos}. | |
2862 @end defun | |
2863 | |
2864 @defun previous-single-property-change pos prop &optional object limit | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2865 This is like @code{next-single-property-change}, but scans back from |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2866 @var{pos} instead of forward. If the value is non-@code{nil}, it is a |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2867 position less than or equal to @var{pos}; it equals @var{pos} only if |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2868 @var{limit} equals @var{pos}. |
6558 | 2869 @end defun |
2870 | |
39528
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2871 @defun next-char-property-change pos &optional limit |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2872 This is like @code{next-property-change} except that it considers |
39528
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2873 overlay properties as well as text properties, and if no change is |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2874 found before the end of the buffer, it returns the maximum buffer |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2875 position rather than @code{nil} (in this sense, it resembles the |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2876 corresponding overlay function @code{next-overlay-change}, rather than |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2877 @code{next-property-change}). There is no @var{object} operand |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2878 because this function operates only on the current buffer. It returns |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2879 the next address at which either kind of property changes. |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2880 @end defun |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2881 |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2882 @defun previous-char-property-change pos &optional limit |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2883 This is like @code{next-char-property-change}, but scans back from |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2884 @var{pos} instead of forward, and returns the minimum buffer |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2885 position if no change is found. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2886 @end defun |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2887 |
39528
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2888 @defun next-single-char-property-change pos prop &optional object limit |
39530
6d1ba806f659
Add @tindex lines to new entries.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39528
diff
changeset
|
2889 @tindex next-single-char-property-change |
39528
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2890 This is like @code{next-single-property-change} except that it |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2891 considers overlay properties as well as text properties, and if no |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2892 change is found before the end of the @var{object}, it returns the |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2893 maximum valid position in @var{object} rather than @code{nil}. Unlike |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2894 @code{next-char-property-change}, this function @emph{does} have an |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2895 @var{object} operand; if @var{object} is not a buffer, only |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2896 text-properties are considered. |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2897 @end defun |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2898 |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2899 @defun previous-single-char-property-change pos prop &optional object limit |
39530
6d1ba806f659
Add @tindex lines to new entries.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39528
diff
changeset
|
2900 @tindex previous-single-char-property-change |
39528
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2901 This is like @code{next-single-char-property-change}, but scans back |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2902 from @var{pos} instead of forward, and returns the minimum valid |
ed97ba5c9ba8
(Property Search): Correct descriptions of
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39208
diff
changeset
|
2903 position in @var{object} if no change is found. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2904 @end defun |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2905 |
6558 | 2906 @defun text-property-any start end prop value &optional object |
2907 This function returns non-@code{nil} if at least one character between | |
2908 @var{start} and @var{end} has a property @var{prop} whose value is | |
2909 @var{value}. More precisely, it returns the position of the first such | |
2910 character. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}. | |
2911 | |
2912 The optional fifth argument, @var{object}, specifies the string or | |
2913 buffer to scan. Positions are relative to @var{object}. The default | |
2914 for @var{object} is the current buffer. | |
2915 @end defun | |
2916 | |
2917 @defun text-property-not-all start end prop value &optional object | |
2918 This function returns non-@code{nil} if at least one character between | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2919 @var{start} and @var{end} does not have a property @var{prop} with value |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2920 @var{value}. More precisely, it returns the position of the first such |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2921 character. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 2922 |
2923 The optional fifth argument, @var{object}, specifies the string or | |
2924 buffer to scan. Positions are relative to @var{object}. The default | |
2925 for @var{object} is the current buffer. | |
2926 @end defun | |
2927 | |
2928 @node Special Properties | |
2929 @subsection Properties with Special Meanings | |
2930 | |
12098 | 2931 Here is a table of text property names that have special built-in |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2932 meanings. The following sections list a few additional special property |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2933 names that control filling and property inheritance. All other names |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2934 have no standard meaning, and you can use them as you like. |
12098 | 2935 |
6558 | 2936 @table @code |
2937 @cindex category of text character | |
2938 @kindex category @r{(text property)} | |
2939 @item category | |
2940 If a character has a @code{category} property, we call it the | |
2941 @dfn{category} of the character. It should be a symbol. The properties | |
2942 of the symbol serve as defaults for the properties of the character. | |
2943 | |
2944 @item face | |
2945 @cindex face codes of text | |
2946 @kindex face @r{(text property)} | |
2947 You can use the property @code{face} to control the font and color of | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2948 text. @xref{Faces}, for more information. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2949 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2950 In the simplest case, the value is a face name. It can also be a list; |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2951 then each element can be any of these possibilities; |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2952 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2953 @itemize @bullet |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2954 @item |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2955 A face name (a symbol or string). |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2956 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2957 @item |
59391
701be29d8965
(Special Properties): Minor change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
58886
diff
changeset
|
2958 A property list of face attributes. This has the |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2959 form (@var{keyword} @var{value} @dots{}), where each @var{keyword} is a |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2960 face attribute name and @var{value} is a meaningful value for that |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2961 attribute. With this feature, you do not need to create a face each |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2962 time you want to specify a particular attribute for certain text. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2963 @xref{Face Attributes}. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2964 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2965 @item |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2966 A cons cell of the form @code{(foreground-color . @var{color-name})} or |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2967 @code{(background-color . @var{color-name})}. These elements specify |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2968 just the foreground color or just the background color. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2969 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2970 @code{(foreground-color . @var{color-name})} is equivalent to |
63583
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
2971 specifying @code{(:foreground @var{color-name})}, and likewise for the |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
2972 background. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2973 @end itemize |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2974 |
45685
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2975 You can use Font Lock Mode (@pxref{Font Lock Mode}), to dynamically |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2976 update @code{face} properties based on the contents of the text. |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2977 |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2978 @item font-lock-face |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2979 @kindex font-lock-face @r{(text property)} |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2980 The @code{font-lock-face} property is the same in all respects as the |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2981 @code{face} property, but its state of activation is controlled by |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2982 @code{font-lock-mode}. This can be advantageous for special buffers |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2983 which are not intended to be user-editable, or for static areas of |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2984 text which are always fontified in the same way. |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2985 @xref{Precalculated Fontification}. |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2986 |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2987 Strictly speaking, @code{font-lock-face} is not a built-in text |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2988 property; rather, it is implemented in Font Lock mode using |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2989 @code{char-property-alias-alist}. @xref{Examining Properties}. |
4ff98d5e3cf5
(char-property-alias-alist): New variable; describe its relation to
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45040
diff
changeset
|
2990 |
59996
aac0a33f5772
Change release version from 21.4 to 22.1 throughout.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59945
diff
changeset
|
2991 This property is new in Emacs 22.1. |
6558 | 2992 |
2993 @item mouse-face | |
2994 @kindex mouse-face @r{(text property)} | |
2995 The property @code{mouse-face} is used instead of @code{face} when the | |
2996 mouse is on or near the character. For this purpose, ``near'' means | |
2997 that all text between the character and where the mouse is have the same | |
2998 @code{mouse-face} property value. | |
2999 | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3000 @item fontified |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3001 @kindex fontified @r{(text property)} |
69578
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3002 This property says whether the text has had faces assigned to it by |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3003 font locking. The display engine tests it to decide whether a buffer |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3004 portion needs refontifying before display. @xref{Auto Faces}. It |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3005 takes one of these three values---other values are invalid: |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3006 |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3007 @table @asis |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3008 @item @code{nil} |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3009 Font locking is disabled, or the @code{face} properties on the text, |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3010 if any, are invalid. |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3011 |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3012 @item The symbol @code{defer} |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3013 This value states that the text's @code{face} properties are invalid |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3014 and marks it for deferred fontification. It is used only when ``just |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3015 in time'' font locking is enabled. |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3016 |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3017 @item @code{t} |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3018 The @code{face} properties, or lack of them, on the text are currently |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3019 valid. |
8d593746aa77
* text.texi (Special Properties): Clarify the definition of
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
69419
diff
changeset
|
3020 @end table |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3021 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3022 @item display |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3023 @kindex display @r{(text property)} |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3024 This property activates various features that change the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3025 way text is displayed. For example, it can make text appear taller |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3026 or shorter, higher or lower, wider or narrow, or replaced with an image. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3027 @xref{Display Property}. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3028 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3029 @item help-echo |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3030 @kindex help-echo @r{(text property)} |
45040
07fdd6ac8356
(Special Properties): Add index entry and xref for tooltips.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43907
diff
changeset
|
3031 @cindex tooltip |
31079 | 3032 @anchor{Text help-echo} |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3033 If text has a string as its @code{help-echo} property, then when you |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3034 move the mouse onto that text, Emacs displays that string in the echo |
45040
07fdd6ac8356
(Special Properties): Add index entry and xref for tooltips.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43907
diff
changeset
|
3035 area, or in the tooltip window (@pxref{Tooltips,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs |
07fdd6ac8356
(Special Properties): Add index entry and xref for tooltips.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43907
diff
changeset
|
3036 Manual}). |
31079 | 3037 |
31372 | 3038 If the value of the @code{help-echo} property is a function, that |
31079 | 3039 function is called with three arguments, @var{window}, @var{object} and |
59770
bea71297b227
(Special Properties) <help-echo>: Use `pos' consistently in description
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
59533
diff
changeset
|
3040 @var{pos} and should return a help string or @code{nil} for |
31079 | 3041 none. The first argument, @var{window} is the window in which |
3042 the help was found. The second, @var{object}, is the buffer, overlay or | |
59770
bea71297b227
(Special Properties) <help-echo>: Use `pos' consistently in description
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
59533
diff
changeset
|
3043 string which had the @code{help-echo} property. The @var{pos} |
31079 | 3044 argument is as follows: |
3045 | |
3046 @itemize @bullet{} | |
3047 @item | |
3048 If @var{object} is a buffer, @var{pos} is the position in the buffer | |
3049 where the @code{help-echo} text property was found. | |
3050 @item | |
3051 If @var{object} is an overlay, that overlay has a @code{help-echo} | |
3052 property, and @var{pos} is the position in the overlay's buffer under | |
3053 the mouse. | |
3054 @item | |
3055 If @var{object} is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed | |
31372 | 3056 with the @code{display} property), @var{pos} is the position in that |
31079 | 3057 string under the mouse. |
3058 @end itemize | |
3059 | |
3060 If the value of the @code{help-echo} property is neither a function nor | |
3061 a string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string. | |
3062 | |
31372 | 3063 You can alter the way help text is displayed by setting the variable |
3064 @code{show-help-function} (@pxref{Help display}). | |
31079 | 3065 |
45750
73b33fa2ec78
Delete "new in Emacs 21" note.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
45685
diff
changeset
|
3066 This feature is used in the mode line and for other active text. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3067 |
43907
bfe50f90f666
Update doc of local-map and keymap text properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41490
diff
changeset
|
3068 @item keymap |
bfe50f90f666
Update doc of local-map and keymap text properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41490
diff
changeset
|
3069 @cindex keymap of character |
bfe50f90f666
Update doc of local-map and keymap text properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41490
diff
changeset
|
3070 @kindex keymap @r{(text property)} |
bfe50f90f666
Update doc of local-map and keymap text properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41490
diff
changeset
|
3071 The @code{keymap} property specifies an additional keymap for |
51911
9c44faf04f59
(Special Properties): local-map and keymap properties
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51702
diff
changeset
|
3072 commands. The property's value for the character before point applies |
9c44faf04f59
(Special Properties): local-map and keymap properties
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51702
diff
changeset
|
3073 if it is non-@code{nil} and rear-sticky, and the property's value for |
9c44faf04f59
(Special Properties): local-map and keymap properties
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51702
diff
changeset
|
3074 the character after point applies if it is non-@code{nil} and |
53435
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
3075 front-sticky. (For mouse clicks, the position of the click is used |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
3076 instead of the position of point.) If the property value is a symbol, |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
3077 the symbol's function definition is used as the keymap. |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
3078 |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
3079 When this keymap applies, it is used for key lookup before the minor |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
3080 mode keymaps and before the buffer's local map. @xref{Active |
0f3abb6bbf27
(Examining Properties): Add get-char-property-and-overlay.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
3081 Keymaps}. |
43907
bfe50f90f666
Update doc of local-map and keymap text properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41490
diff
changeset
|
3082 |
29102 | 3083 @item local-map |
3084 @kindex local-map @r{(text property)} | |
51911
9c44faf04f59
(Special Properties): local-map and keymap properties
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51702
diff
changeset
|
3085 This property works like @code{keymap} except that it specifies a |
9c44faf04f59
(Special Properties): local-map and keymap properties
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51702
diff
changeset
|
3086 keymap to use @emph{instead of} the buffer's local map. For most |
9c44faf04f59
(Special Properties): local-map and keymap properties
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51702
diff
changeset
|
3087 purposes (perhaps all purposes), the @code{keymap} is superior. |
34000 | 3088 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3089 @item syntax-table |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3090 The @code{syntax-table} property overrides what the syntax table says |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3091 about this particular character. @xref{Syntax Properties}. |
6558 | 3092 |
3093 @item read-only | |
3094 @cindex read-only character | |
3095 @kindex read-only @r{(text property)} | |
3096 If a character has the property @code{read-only}, then modifying that | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3097 character is not allowed. Any command that would do so gets an error, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3098 @code{text-read-only}. |
6558 | 3099 |
3100 Insertion next to a read-only character is an error if inserting | |
3101 ordinary text there would inherit the @code{read-only} property due to | |
3102 stickiness. Thus, you can control permission to insert next to | |
3103 read-only text by controlling the stickiness. @xref{Sticky Properties}. | |
3104 | |
3105 Since changing properties counts as modifying the buffer, it is not | |
3106 possible to remove a @code{read-only} property unless you know the | |
3107 special trick: bind @code{inhibit-read-only} to a non-@code{nil} value | |
3108 and then remove the property. @xref{Read Only Buffers}. | |
3109 | |
3110 @item invisible | |
3111 @kindex invisible @r{(text property)} | |
12067 | 3112 A non-@code{nil} @code{invisible} property can make a character invisible |
3113 on the screen. @xref{Invisible Text}, for details. | |
6558 | 3114 |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3115 @item intangible |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3116 @kindex intangible @r{(text property)} |
12067 | 3117 If a group of consecutive characters have equal and non-@code{nil} |
3118 @code{intangible} properties, then you cannot place point between them. | |
12098 | 3119 If you try to move point forward into the group, point actually moves to |
3120 the end of the group. If you try to move point backward into the group, | |
12067 | 3121 point actually moves to the start of the group. |
3122 | |
3123 When the variable @code{inhibit-point-motion-hooks} is non-@code{nil}, | |
3124 the @code{intangible} property is ignored. | |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3125 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3126 @item field |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3127 @kindex field @r{(text property)} |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3128 Consecutive characters with the same @code{field} property constitute a |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3129 @dfn{field}. Some motion functions including @code{forward-word} and |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3130 @code{beginning-of-line} stop moving at a field boundary. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3131 @xref{Fields}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3132 |
57192
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3133 @item cursor |
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3134 @kindex cursor @r{(text property)} |
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3135 Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and text |
57222
f0af4b0029b5
(Special Properties): Cleanups in `cursor'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57192
diff
changeset
|
3136 property strings present at the current window position. You can |
f0af4b0029b5
(Special Properties): Cleanups in `cursor'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57192
diff
changeset
|
3137 place the cursor on any desired character of these strings by giving |
57192
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3138 that character a non-@code{nil} @var{cursor} text property. |
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3139 |
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3140 @item pointer |
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3141 @kindex pointer @r{(text property)} |
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3142 This specifies a specific pointer shape when the mouse pointer is over |
63353
138377d5ea9f
(Special Properties): Fix cross reference.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
63316
diff
changeset
|
3143 this text or image. @xref{Pointer Shape}, for possible pointer |
138377d5ea9f
(Special Properties): Fix cross reference.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
63316
diff
changeset
|
3144 shapes. |
57192
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3145 |
57222
f0af4b0029b5
(Special Properties): Cleanups in `cursor'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57192
diff
changeset
|
3146 @item line-spacing |
f0af4b0029b5
(Special Properties): Cleanups in `cursor'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57192
diff
changeset
|
3147 @kindex line-spacing @r{(text property)} |
57253
1aa63962c3cf
(Special Properties): Clarify line-spacing and line-height.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57222
diff
changeset
|
3148 A newline can have a @code{line-spacing} text or overlay property that |
1aa63962c3cf
(Special Properties): Clarify line-spacing and line-height.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57222
diff
changeset
|
3149 controls the height of the display line ending with that newline. The |
1aa63962c3cf
(Special Properties): Clarify line-spacing and line-height.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57222
diff
changeset
|
3150 property value overrides the default frame line spacing and the buffer |
58886
bf57a566c090
* text.texi (Special Properties): Just mention line-spacing and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
58748
diff
changeset
|
3151 local @code{line-spacing} variable. @xref{Line Height}. |
57222
f0af4b0029b5
(Special Properties): Cleanups in `cursor'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57192
diff
changeset
|
3152 |
57192
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3153 @item line-height |
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3154 @kindex line-height @r{(text property)} |
57222
f0af4b0029b5
(Special Properties): Cleanups in `cursor'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57192
diff
changeset
|
3155 A newline can have a @code{line-height} text or overlay property that |
57253
1aa63962c3cf
(Special Properties): Clarify line-spacing and line-height.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
57222
diff
changeset
|
3156 controls the total height of the display line ending in that newline. |
58886
bf57a566c090
* text.texi (Special Properties): Just mention line-spacing and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
58748
diff
changeset
|
3157 @xref{Line Height}. |
57192
ba03d6f29083
(Special Properties): Add `cursor', `pointer',
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54916
diff
changeset
|
3158 |
6558 | 3159 @item modification-hooks |
3160 @cindex change hooks for a character | |
3161 @cindex hooks for changing a character | |
3162 @kindex modification-hooks @r{(text property)} | |
3163 If a character has the property @code{modification-hooks}, then its | |
3164 value should be a list of functions; modifying that character calls all | |
3165 of those functions. Each function receives two arguments: the beginning | |
3166 and end of the part of the buffer being modified. Note that if a | |
3167 particular modification hook function appears on several characters | |
3168 being modified by a single primitive, you can't predict how many times | |
3169 the function will be called. | |
3170 | |
63950
a56fccc4986b
(Special Properties): Change hook functions should bind
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63609
diff
changeset
|
3171 If these functions modify the buffer, they should bind |
a56fccc4986b
(Special Properties): Change hook functions should bind
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63609
diff
changeset
|
3172 @code{inhibit-modification-hooks} to @code{t} around doing so, to |
a56fccc4986b
(Special Properties): Change hook functions should bind
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63609
diff
changeset
|
3173 avoid confusing the internal mechanism that calls these hooks. |
a56fccc4986b
(Special Properties): Change hook functions should bind
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63609
diff
changeset
|
3174 |
6558 | 3175 @item insert-in-front-hooks |
3176 @itemx insert-behind-hooks | |
3177 @kindex insert-in-front-hooks @r{(text property)} | |
3178 @kindex insert-behind-hooks @r{(text property)} | |
16398
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
3179 The operation of inserting text in a buffer also calls the functions |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
3180 listed in the @code{insert-in-front-hooks} property of the following |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
3181 character and in the @code{insert-behind-hooks} property of the |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
3182 preceding character. These functions receive two arguments, the |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
3183 beginning and end of the inserted text. The functions are called |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
3184 @emph{after} the actual insertion takes place. |
6558 | 3185 |
3186 See also @ref{Change Hooks}, for other hooks that are called | |
3187 when you change text in a buffer. | |
3188 | |
3189 @item point-entered | |
3190 @itemx point-left | |
3191 @cindex hooks for motion of point | |
3192 @kindex point-entered @r{(text property)} | |
3193 @kindex point-left @r{(text property)} | |
3194 The special properties @code{point-entered} and @code{point-left} | |
3195 record hook functions that report motion of point. Each time point | |
3196 moves, Emacs compares these two property values: | |
3197 | |
3198 @itemize @bullet | |
3199 @item | |
3200 the @code{point-left} property of the character after the old location, | |
3201 and | |
3202 @item | |
3203 the @code{point-entered} property of the character after the new | |
3204 location. | |
3205 @end itemize | |
3206 | |
3207 @noindent | |
3208 If these two values differ, each of them is called (if not @code{nil}) | |
3209 with two arguments: the old value of point, and the new one. | |
3210 | |
3211 The same comparison is made for the characters before the old and new | |
3212 locations. The result may be to execute two @code{point-left} functions | |
3213 (which may be the same function) and/or two @code{point-entered} | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3214 functions (which may be the same function). In any case, all the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3215 @code{point-left} functions are called first, followed by all the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3216 @code{point-entered} functions. |
6558 | 3217 |
54041 | 3218 It is possible with @code{char-after} to examine characters at various |
3219 buffer positions without moving point to those positions. Only an | |
3220 actual change in the value of point runs these hook functions. | |
6558 | 3221 @end table |
3222 | |
3223 @defvar inhibit-point-motion-hooks | |
3224 When this variable is non-@code{nil}, @code{point-left} and | |
12067 | 3225 @code{point-entered} hooks are not run, and the @code{intangible} |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3226 property has no effect. Do not set this variable globally; bind it with |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3227 @code{let}. |
6558 | 3228 @end defvar |
3229 | |
31079 | 3230 @defvar show-help-function |
3231 @tindex show-help-function | |
31372 | 3232 @anchor{Help display} If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it specifies a |
3233 function called to display help strings. These may be @code{help-echo} | |
3234 properties, menu help strings (@pxref{Simple Menu Items}, | |
3235 @pxref{Extended Menu Items}), or tool bar help strings (@pxref{Tool | |
3236 Bar}). The specified function is called with one argument, the help | |
38581 | 3237 string to display. Tooltip mode (@pxref{Tooltips,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs |
3238 Manual}) provides an example. | |
31079 | 3239 @end defvar |
3240 | |
12067 | 3241 @node Format Properties |
12098 | 3242 @subsection Formatted Text Properties |
12067 | 3243 |
3244 These text properties affect the behavior of the fill commands. They | |
12098 | 3245 are used for representing formatted text. @xref{Filling}, and |
3246 @ref{Margins}. | |
3247 | |
3248 @table @code | |
12067 | 3249 @item hard |
3250 If a newline character has this property, it is a ``hard'' newline. | |
3251 The fill commands do not alter hard newlines and do not move words | |
59880
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
3252 across them. However, this property takes effect only if the |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
3253 @code{use-hard-newlines} minor mode is enabled. @xref{Hard and Soft |
8e65810e7f24
(User-Level Deletion): just-one-space takes numeric arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59838
diff
changeset
|
3254 Newlines,, Hard and Soft Newlines, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}. |
12067 | 3255 |
3256 @item right-margin | |
12098 | 3257 This property specifies an extra right margin for filling this part of the |
12067 | 3258 text. |
3259 | |
3260 @item left-margin | |
12098 | 3261 This property specifies an extra left margin for filling this part of the |
12067 | 3262 text. |
3263 | |
3264 @item justification | |
3265 This property specifies the style of justification for filling this part | |
3266 of the text. | |
3267 @end table | |
3268 | |
6558 | 3269 @node Sticky Properties |
3270 @subsection Stickiness of Text Properties | |
3271 @cindex sticky text properties | |
3272 @cindex inheritance of text properties | |
3273 | |
3274 Self-inserting characters normally take on the same properties as the | |
3275 preceding character. This is called @dfn{inheritance} of properties. | |
3276 | |
3277 In a Lisp program, you can do insertion with inheritance or without, | |
3278 depending on your choice of insertion primitive. The ordinary text | |
3279 insertion functions such as @code{insert} do not inherit any properties. | |
3280 They insert text with precisely the properties of the string being | |
3281 inserted, and no others. This is correct for programs that copy text | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3282 from one context to another---for example, into or out of the kill ring. |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3283 To insert with inheritance, use the special primitives described in this |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3284 section. Self-inserting characters inherit properties because they work |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3285 using these primitives. |
6558 | 3286 |
3287 When you do insertion with inheritance, @emph{which} properties are | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3288 inherited, and from where, depends on which properties are @dfn{sticky}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3289 Insertion after a character inherits those of its properties that are |
6558 | 3290 @dfn{rear-sticky}. Insertion before a character inherits those of its |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3291 properties that are @dfn{front-sticky}. When both sides offer different |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3292 sticky values for the same property, the previous character's value |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3293 takes precedence. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3294 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3295 By default, a text property is rear-sticky but not front-sticky; thus, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3296 the default is to inherit all the properties of the preceding character, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3297 and nothing from the following character. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3298 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3299 You can control the stickiness of various text properties with two |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3300 specific text properties, @code{front-sticky} and @code{rear-nonsticky}, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3301 and with the variable @code{text-property-default-nonsticky}. You can |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3302 use the variable to specify a different default for a given property. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3303 You can use those two text properties to make any specific properties |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3304 sticky or nonsticky in any particular part of the text. |
6558 | 3305 |
3306 If a character's @code{front-sticky} property is @code{t}, then all | |
3307 its properties are front-sticky. If the @code{front-sticky} property is | |
3308 a list, then the sticky properties of the character are those whose | |
3309 names are in the list. For example, if a character has a | |
3310 @code{front-sticky} property whose value is @code{(face read-only)}, | |
3311 then insertion before the character can inherit its @code{face} property | |
3312 and its @code{read-only} property, but no others. | |
3313 | |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3314 The @code{rear-nonsticky} property works the opposite way. Most |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3315 properties are rear-sticky by default, so the @code{rear-nonsticky} |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3316 property says which properties are @emph{not} rear-sticky. If a |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3317 character's @code{rear-nonsticky} property is @code{t}, then none of its |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3318 properties are rear-sticky. If the @code{rear-nonsticky} property is a |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3319 list, properties are rear-sticky @emph{unless} their names are in the |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3320 list. |
6558 | 3321 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3322 @defvar text-property-default-nonsticky |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3323 @tindex text-property-default-nonsticky |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3324 This variable holds an alist which defines the default rear-stickiness |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3325 of various text properties. Each element has the form |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3326 @code{(@var{property} . @var{nonstickiness})}, and it defines the |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3327 stickiness of a particular text property, @var{property}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3328 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3329 If @var{nonstickiness} is non-@code{nil}, this means that the property |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3330 @var{property} is rear-nonsticky by default. Since all properties are |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3331 front-nonsticky by default, this makes @var{property} nonsticky in both |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3332 directions by default. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3333 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3334 The text properties @code{front-sticky} and @code{rear-nonsticky}, when |
47475 | 3335 used, take precedence over the default @var{nonstickiness} specified in |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3336 @code{text-property-default-nonsticky}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3337 @end defvar |
6558 | 3338 |
3339 Here are the functions that insert text with inheritance of properties: | |
3340 | |
3341 @defun insert-and-inherit &rest strings | |
3342 Insert the strings @var{strings}, just like the function @code{insert}, | |
3343 but inherit any sticky properties from the adjoining text. | |
3344 @end defun | |
3345 | |
3346 @defun insert-before-markers-and-inherit &rest strings | |
3347 Insert the strings @var{strings}, just like the function | |
3348 @code{insert-before-markers}, but inherit any sticky properties from the | |
3349 adjoining text. | |
3350 @end defun | |
3351 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3352 @xref{Insertion}, for the ordinary insertion functions which do not |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3353 inherit. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3354 |
6558 | 3355 @node Saving Properties |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3356 @subsection Saving Text Properties in Files |
6558 | 3357 @cindex text properties in files |
3358 @cindex saving text properties | |
3359 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3360 You can save text properties in files (along with the text itself), |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3361 and restore the same text properties when visiting or inserting the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3362 files, using these two hooks: |
6558 | 3363 |
12098 | 3364 @defvar write-region-annotate-functions |
6558 | 3365 This variable's value is a list of functions for @code{write-region} to |
3366 run to encode text properties in some fashion as annotations to the text | |
3367 being written in the file. @xref{Writing to Files}. | |
3368 | |
3369 Each function in the list is called with two arguments: the start and | |
3370 end of the region to be written. These functions should not alter the | |
3371 contents of the buffer. Instead, they should return lists indicating | |
3372 annotations to write in the file in addition to the text in the | |
3373 buffer. | |
3374 | |
3375 Each function should return a list of elements of the form | |
3376 @code{(@var{position} . @var{string})}, where @var{position} is an | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3377 integer specifying the relative position within the text to be written, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3378 and @var{string} is the annotation to add there. |
6558 | 3379 |
3380 Each list returned by one of these functions must be already sorted in | |
3381 increasing order by @var{position}. If there is more than one function, | |
3382 @code{write-region} merges the lists destructively into one sorted list. | |
3383 | |
3384 When @code{write-region} actually writes the text from the buffer to the | |
3385 file, it intermixes the specified annotations at the corresponding | |
3386 positions. All this takes place without modifying the buffer. | |
3387 @end defvar | |
3388 | |
3389 @defvar after-insert-file-functions | |
3390 This variable holds a list of functions for @code{insert-file-contents} | |
3391 to call after inserting a file's contents. These functions should scan | |
3392 the inserted text for annotations, and convert them to the text | |
3393 properties they stand for. | |
3394 | |
3395 Each function receives one argument, the length of the inserted text; | |
3396 point indicates the start of that text. The function should scan that | |
3397 text for annotations, delete them, and create the text properties that | |
3398 the annotations specify. The function should return the updated length | |
3399 of the inserted text, as it stands after those changes. The value | |
3400 returned by one function becomes the argument to the next function. | |
3401 | |
3402 These functions should always return with point at the beginning of | |
3403 the inserted text. | |
3404 | |
3405 The intended use of @code{after-insert-file-functions} is for converting | |
3406 some sort of textual annotations into actual text properties. But other | |
3407 uses may be possible. | |
3408 @end defvar | |
3409 | |
3410 We invite users to write Lisp programs to store and retrieve text | |
3411 properties in files, using these hooks, and thus to experiment with | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49184
diff
changeset
|
3412 various data formats and find good ones. Eventually we hope users |
6558 | 3413 will produce good, general extensions we can install in Emacs. |
3414 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3415 We suggest not trying to handle arbitrary Lisp objects as text property |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3416 names or values---because a program that general is probably difficult |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3417 to write, and slow. Instead, choose a set of possible data types that |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3418 are reasonably flexible, and not too hard to encode. |
6558 | 3419 |
12098 | 3420 @xref{Format Conversion}, for a related feature. |
3421 | |
3422 @c ??? In next edition, merge this info Format Conversion. | |
3423 | |
15760
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3424 @node Lazy Properties |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3425 @subsection Lazy Computation of Text Properties |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3426 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3427 Instead of computing text properties for all the text in the buffer, |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3428 you can arrange to compute the text properties for parts of the text |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3429 when and if something depends on them. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3430 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3431 The primitive that extracts text from the buffer along with its |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3432 properties is @code{buffer-substring}. Before examining the properties, |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3433 this function runs the abnormal hook @code{buffer-access-fontify-functions}. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3434 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3435 @defvar buffer-access-fontify-functions |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3436 This variable holds a list of functions for computing text properties. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3437 Before @code{buffer-substring} copies the text and text properties for a |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3438 portion of the buffer, it calls all the functions in this list. Each of |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3439 the functions receives two arguments that specify the range of the |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3440 buffer being accessed. (The buffer itself is always the current |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3441 buffer.) |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3442 @end defvar |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3443 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3444 The function @code{buffer-substring-no-properties} does not call these |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3445 functions, since it ignores text properties anyway. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3446 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3447 In order to prevent the hook functions from being called more than |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3448 once for the same part of the buffer, you can use the variable |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3449 @code{buffer-access-fontified-property}. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3450 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3451 @defvar buffer-access-fontified-property |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3452 If this value's variable is non-@code{nil}, it is a symbol which is used |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3453 as a text property name. A non-@code{nil} value for that text property |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3454 means, ``the other text properties for this character have already been |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3455 computed.'' |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3456 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3457 If all the characters in the range specified for @code{buffer-substring} |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3458 have a non-@code{nil} value for this property, @code{buffer-substring} |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3459 does not call the @code{buffer-access-fontify-functions} functions. It |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3460 assumes these characters already have the right text properties, and |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3461 just copies the properties they already have. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3462 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3463 The normal way to use this feature is that the |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3464 @code{buffer-access-fontify-functions} functions add this property, as |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3465 well as others, to the characters they operate on. That way, they avoid |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3466 being called over and over for the same text. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3467 @end defvar |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3468 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3469 @node Clickable Text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3470 @subsection Defining Clickable Text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3471 @cindex clickable text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3472 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3473 There are two ways to set up @dfn{clickable text} in a buffer. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3474 There are typically two parts of this: to make the text highlight |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3475 when the mouse is over it, and to make a mouse button do something |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3476 when you click it on that part of the text. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3477 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3478 Highlighting is done with the @code{mouse-face} text property. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3479 Here is an example of how Dired does it: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3480 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3481 @smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3482 (condition-case nil |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3483 (if (dired-move-to-filename) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3484 (put-text-property (point) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3485 (save-excursion |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3486 (dired-move-to-end-of-filename) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3487 (point)) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3488 'mouse-face 'highlight)) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3489 (error nil)) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3490 @end smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3491 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3492 @noindent |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3493 The first two arguments to @code{put-text-property} specify the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3494 beginning and end of the text. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3495 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3496 The usual way to make the mouse do something when you click it |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3497 on this text is to define @code{mouse-2} in the major mode's |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3498 keymap. The job of checking whether the click was on clickable text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3499 is done by the command definition. Here is how Dired does it: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3500 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3501 @smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3502 (defun dired-mouse-find-file-other-window (event) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3503 "In dired, visit the file or directory name you click on." |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3504 (interactive "e") |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3505 (let (file) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3506 (save-excursion |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3507 (set-buffer (window-buffer (posn-window (event-end event)))) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3508 (save-excursion |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3509 (goto-char (posn-point (event-end event))) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3510 (setq file (dired-get-filename)))) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3511 (select-window (posn-window (event-end event))) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3512 (find-file-other-window (file-name-sans-versions file t)))) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3513 @end smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3514 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3515 @noindent |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3516 The reason for the outer @code{save-excursion} construct is to avoid |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3517 changing the current buffer; the reason for the inner one is to avoid |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3518 permanently altering point in the buffer you click on. In this case, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3519 Dired uses the function @code{dired-get-filename} to determine which |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3520 file to visit, based on the position found in the event. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3521 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3522 Instead of defining a mouse command for the major mode, you can define |
31586 | 3523 a key binding for the clickable text itself, using the @code{keymap} |
29102 | 3524 text property: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3525 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3526 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3527 (let ((map (make-sparse-keymap))) |
31586 | 3528 (define-key map [mouse-2] 'operate-this-button) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3529 (put-text-property (point) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3530 (save-excursion |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3531 (dired-move-to-end-of-filename) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3532 (point)) |
31586 | 3533 'keymap map)) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3534 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3535 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3536 @noindent |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3537 This method makes it possible to define different commands for various |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3538 clickable pieces of text. Also, the major mode definition (or the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3539 global definition) remains available for the rest of the text in the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3540 buffer. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3541 |
59504
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3542 @node Links and Mouse-1 |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3543 @subsection Links and Mouse-1 |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3544 @cindex follow links |
59504
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3545 @cindex mouse-1 |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3546 |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3547 The normal Emacs command for activating text in read-only buffers is |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3548 @key{Mouse-2}, which includes following textual links. However, most |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3549 graphical applications use @key{Mouse-1} for following links. For |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3550 compatibility, @key{Mouse-1} follows links in Emacs too, when you |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3551 click on a link quickly without moving the mouse. The user can |
63609 | 3552 customize this behavior through the variable |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3553 @code{mouse-1-click-follows-link}. |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3554 |
59504
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3555 To define text as a link at the Lisp level, you should bind the |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3556 @code{mouse-2} event to a command to follow the link. Then, to indicate that |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3557 @key{Mouse-1} should also follow the link, you should specify a |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3558 @code{follow-link} condition either as a text property or as a key |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3559 binding: |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3560 |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3561 @table @asis |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3562 @item @code{follow-link} property |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3563 If the clickable text has a non-@code{nil} @code{follow-link} text or overlay |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3564 property, that specifies the condition. |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3565 |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3566 @item @code{follow-link} event |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3567 If there is a binding for the @code{follow-link} event, either on the |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3568 clickable text or in the local keymap, the binding is the condition. |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3569 @end table |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3570 |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3571 Regardless of how you set the @code{follow-link} condition, its |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3572 value is used as follows to determine whether the given position is |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3573 inside a link, and (if so) to compute an @dfn{action code} saying how |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3574 @key{Mouse-1} should handle the link. |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3575 |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3576 @table @asis |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3577 @item @code{mouse-face} |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3578 If the condition is @code{mouse-face}, a position is inside a link if |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3579 there is a non-@code{nil} @code{mouse-face} property at that position. |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3580 The action code is always @code{t}. |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3581 |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3582 For example, here is how Info mode handles @key{Mouse-1}: |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3583 |
63583
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
3584 @smallexample |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3585 (define-key Info-mode-map [follow-link] 'mouse-face) |
63583
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
3586 @end smallexample |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3587 |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3588 @item a function |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3589 If the condition is a valid function, @var{func}, then a position |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3590 @var{pos} is inside a link if @code{(@var{func} @var{pos})} evaluates |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3591 to non-@code{nil}. The value returned by @var{func} serves as the |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3592 action code. |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3593 |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3594 For example, here is how pcvs enables @key{Mouse-1} to follow links on |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3595 file names only: |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3596 |
63583
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
3597 @smallexample |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3598 (define-key map [follow-link] |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3599 (lambda (pos) |
63583
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
3600 (eq (get-char-property pos 'face) 'cvs-filename-face))) |
99e9892a51d9
Fix formatting ugliness.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
63353
diff
changeset
|
3601 @end smallexample |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3602 |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3603 @item anything else |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3604 If the condition value is anything else, then the position is inside a |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3605 link and the condition itself is the action code. Clearly you should |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3606 only specify this kind of condition on the text that constitutes a |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3607 link. |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3608 @end table |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3609 |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3610 @noindent |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3611 The action code tells @key{Mouse-1} how to follow the link: |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3612 |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3613 @table @asis |
59533
2a346f1b2a9f
(Links and Mouse-1): Fix string and vector item.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59524
diff
changeset
|
3614 @item a string or vector |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3615 If the action code is a string or vector, the @key{Mouse-1} event is |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3616 translated into the first element of the string or vector; i.e., the |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3617 action of the @key{Mouse-1} click is the local or global binding of |
59533
2a346f1b2a9f
(Links and Mouse-1): Fix string and vector item.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59524
diff
changeset
|
3618 that character or symbol. Thus, if the action code is @code{"foo"}, |
59524
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3619 @key{Mouse-1} translates into @kbd{f}. If it is @code{[foo]}, |
8f17a7431c8a
(Links and Mouse-1): Clarify text.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59504
diff
changeset
|
3620 @key{Mouse-1} translates into @key{foo}. |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3621 |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3622 @item anything else |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3623 For any other non-@code{nil} action code, the @code{mouse-1} event is |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3624 translated into a @code{mouse-2} event at the same position. |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3625 @end table |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3626 |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3627 To define @key{Mouse-1} to activate a button defined with |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3628 @code{define-button-type}, give the button a @code{follow-link} |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3629 property with a value as specified above to determine how to follow |
59504
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3630 the link. For example, here is how Help mode handles @key{Mouse-1}: |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3631 |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3632 @smallexample |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3633 (define-button-type 'help-xref |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3634 'follow-link t |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3635 'action #'help-button-action) |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3636 @end smallexample |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3637 |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3638 To define @key{Mouse-1} on a widget defined with |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3639 @code{define-widget}, give the widget a @code{:follow-link} property |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3640 with a value as specified above to determine how to follow the link. |
59504
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3641 |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3642 For example, here is how the @code{link} widget specifies that |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3643 a @key{Mouse-1} click shall be translated to @key{RET}: |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3644 |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3645 @smallexample |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3646 (define-widget 'link 'item |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3647 "An embedded link." |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3648 :button-prefix 'widget-link-prefix |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3649 :button-suffix 'widget-link-suffix |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3650 :follow-link "\C-m" |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3651 :help-echo "Follow the link." |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3652 :format "%[%t%]") |
66f927c186ac
(Links and Mouse-1): Rename section from Enabling
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59494
diff
changeset
|
3653 @end smallexample |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3654 |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3655 @defun mouse-on-link-p pos |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3656 @tindex mouse-on-link-p |
59494
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3657 This function returns non-@code{nil} if position @var{pos} in the |
d8cf3d034936
(Enabling Mouse-1 to Follow Links): Rewrite.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59464
diff
changeset
|
3658 current buffer is on a link. |
59464
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3659 @end defun |
07659a11876d
(Text Properties): Add "Enable Mouse-1" to submenu.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59391
diff
changeset
|
3660 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3661 @node Fields |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3662 @subsection Defining and Using Fields |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3663 @cindex fields |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3664 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3665 A field is a range of consecutive characters in the buffer that are |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3666 identified by having the same value (comparing with @code{eq}) of the |
32091 | 3667 @code{field} property (either a text-property or an overlay property). |
3668 This section describes special functions that are available for | |
3669 operating on fields. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3670 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3671 You specify a field with a buffer position, @var{pos}. We think of |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3672 each field as containing a range of buffer positions, so the position |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3673 you specify stands for the field containing that position. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3674 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3675 When the characters before and after @var{pos} are part of the same |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3676 field, there is no doubt which field contains @var{pos}: the one those |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3677 characters both belong to. When @var{pos} is at a boundary between |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3678 fields, which field it belongs to depends on the stickiness of the |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3679 @code{field} properties of the two surrounding characters (@pxref{Sticky |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3680 Properties}). The field whose property would be inherited by text |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3681 inserted at @var{pos} is the field that contains @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3682 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3683 There is an anomalous case where newly inserted text at @var{pos} |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3684 would not inherit the @code{field} property from either side. This |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3685 happens if the previous character's @code{field} property is not |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3686 rear-sticky, and the following character's @code{field} property is not |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3687 front-sticky. In this case, @var{pos} belongs to neither the preceding |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3688 field nor the following field; the field functions treat it as belonging |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3689 to an empty field whose beginning and end are both at @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3690 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3691 In all of these functions, if @var{pos} is omitted or @code{nil}, the |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3692 value of point is used by default. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3693 |
41490
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3694 @defun field-beginning &optional pos escape-from-edge limit |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3695 @tindex field-beginning |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3696 This function returns the beginning of the field specified by @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3697 |
32091 | 3698 If @var{pos} is at the beginning of its field, and |
3699 @var{escape-from-edge} is non-@code{nil}, then the return value is | |
3700 always the beginning of the preceding field that @emph{ends} at @var{pos}, | |
3701 regardless of the stickiness of the @code{field} properties around | |
3702 @var{pos}. | |
41490
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3703 |
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3704 If @var{limit} is non-@code{nil}, it is a buffer position; if the |
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3705 beginning of the field is before @var{limit}, then @var{limit} will be |
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3706 returned instead. |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3707 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3708 |
41490
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3709 @defun field-end &optional pos escape-from-edge limit |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3710 @tindex field-end |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3711 This function returns the end of the field specified by @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3712 |
32091 | 3713 If @var{pos} is at the end of its field, and @var{escape-from-edge} is |
3714 non-@code{nil}, then the return value is always the end of the following | |
3715 field that @emph{begins} at @var{pos}, regardless of the stickiness of | |
3716 the @code{field} properties around @var{pos}. | |
41490
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3717 |
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3718 If @var{limit} is non-@code{nil}, it is a buffer position; if the end |
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3719 of the field is after @var{limit}, then @var{limit} will be returned |
794e4afabce0
(Fields): Describe new `limit' arg in field-beginning/field-end.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
40588
diff
changeset
|
3720 instead. |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3721 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3722 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3723 @defun field-string &optional pos |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3724 @tindex field-string |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3725 This function returns the contents of the field specified by @var{pos}, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3726 as a string. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3727 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3728 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3729 @defun field-string-no-properties &optional pos |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3730 @tindex field-string-no-properties |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3731 This function returns the contents of the field specified by @var{pos}, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3732 as a string, discarding text properties. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3733 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3734 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3735 @defun delete-field &optional pos |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3736 @tindex delete-field |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3737 This function deletes the text of the field specified by @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3738 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3739 |
32091 | 3740 @defun constrain-to-field new-pos old-pos &optional escape-from-edge only-in-line inhibit-capture-property |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3741 @tindex constrain-to-field |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3742 This function ``constrains'' @var{new-pos} to the field that |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3743 @var{old-pos} belongs to---in other words, it returns the position |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3744 closest to @var{new-pos} that is in the same field as @var{old-pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3745 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3746 If @var{new-pos} is @code{nil}, then @code{constrain-to-field} uses |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3747 the value of point instead, and moves point to the resulting position. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3748 |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3749 If @var{old-pos} is at the boundary of two fields, then the acceptable |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3750 positions for @var{new-pos} depend on the value of the optional argument |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3751 @var{escape-from-edge}. If @var{escape-from-edge} is @code{nil}, then |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3752 @var{new-pos} is constrained to the field that has the same @code{field} |
32091 | 3753 property (either a text-property or an overlay property) that new |
3754 characters inserted at @var{old-pos} would get. (This depends on the | |
3755 stickiness of the @code{field} property for the characters before and | |
3756 after @var{old-pos}.) If @var{escape-from-edge} is non-@code{nil}, | |
3757 @var{new-pos} is constrained to the union of the two adjacent fields. | |
3758 Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with the | |
3759 special value @code{boundary}, then any point within this special field | |
3760 is also considered to be ``on the boundary.'' | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3761 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3762 If the optional argument @var{only-in-line} is non-@code{nil}, and |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3763 constraining @var{new-pos} in the usual way would move it to a different |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3764 line, @var{new-pos} is returned unconstrained. This used in commands |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3765 that move by line, such as @code{next-line} and |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3766 @code{beginning-of-line}, so that they respect field boundaries only in |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3767 the case where they can still move to the right line. |
32091 | 3768 |
3769 If the optional argument @var{inhibit-capture-property} is | |
3770 non-@code{nil}, and @var{old-pos} has a non-@code{nil} property of that | |
3771 name, then any field boundaries are ignored. | |
3772 | |
3773 You can cause @code{constrain-to-field} to ignore all field boundaries | |
3774 (and so never constrain anything) by binding the variable | |
51702
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
3775 @code{inhibit-field-text-motion} to a non-@code{nil} value. |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3776 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3777 |
6558 | 3778 @node Not Intervals |
3779 @subsection Why Text Properties are not Intervals | |
3780 @cindex intervals | |
3781 | |
3782 Some editors that support adding attributes to text in the buffer do | |
3783 so by letting the user specify ``intervals'' within the text, and adding | |
3784 the properties to the intervals. Those editors permit the user or the | |
3785 programmer to determine where individual intervals start and end. We | |
3786 deliberately provided a different sort of interface in Emacs Lisp to | |
3787 avoid certain paradoxical behavior associated with text modification. | |
3788 | |
3789 If the actual subdivision into intervals is meaningful, that means you | |
3790 can distinguish between a buffer that is just one interval with a | |
3791 certain property, and a buffer containing the same text subdivided into | |
3792 two intervals, both of which have that property. | |
3793 | |
3794 Suppose you take the buffer with just one interval and kill part of | |
3795 the text. The text remaining in the buffer is one interval, and the | |
3796 copy in the kill ring (and the undo list) becomes a separate interval. | |
3797 Then if you yank back the killed text, you get two intervals with the | |
3798 same properties. Thus, editing does not preserve the distinction | |
3799 between one interval and two. | |
3800 | |
3801 Suppose we ``fix'' this problem by coalescing the two intervals when | |
3802 the text is inserted. That works fine if the buffer originally was a | |
3803 single interval. But suppose instead that we have two adjacent | |
3804 intervals with the same properties, and we kill the text of one interval | |
3805 and yank it back. The same interval-coalescence feature that rescues | |
3806 the other case causes trouble in this one: after yanking, we have just | |
3807 one interval. One again, editing does not preserve the distinction | |
3808 between one interval and two. | |
3809 | |
3810 Insertion of text at the border between intervals also raises | |
3811 questions that have no satisfactory answer. | |
3812 | |
3813 However, it is easy to arrange for editing to behave consistently for | |
3814 questions of the form, ``What are the properties of this character?'' | |
3815 So we have decided these are the only questions that make sense; we have | |
3816 not implemented asking questions about where intervals start or end. | |
3817 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3818 In practice, you can usually use the text property search functions in |
6558 | 3819 place of explicit interval boundaries. You can think of them as finding |
3820 the boundaries of intervals, assuming that intervals are always | |
3821 coalesced whenever possible. @xref{Property Search}. | |
3822 | |
3823 Emacs also provides explicit intervals as a presentation feature; see | |
3824 @ref{Overlays}. | |
3825 | |
3826 @node Substitution | |
3827 @section Substituting for a Character Code | |
3828 | |
3829 The following functions replace characters within a specified region | |
3830 based on their character codes. | |
3831 | |
3832 @defun subst-char-in-region start end old-char new-char &optional noundo | |
3833 @cindex replace characters | |
3834 This function replaces all occurrences of the character @var{old-char} | |
3835 with the character @var{new-char} in the region of the current buffer | |
3836 defined by @var{start} and @var{end}. | |
3837 | |
3838 @cindex undo avoidance | |
12098 | 3839 If @var{noundo} is non-@code{nil}, then @code{subst-char-in-region} does |
3840 not record the change for undo and does not mark the buffer as modified. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3841 This was useful for controlling the old selective display feature |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3842 (@pxref{Selective Display}). |
6558 | 3843 |
3844 @code{subst-char-in-region} does not move point and returns | |
3845 @code{nil}. | |
3846 | |
3847 @example | |
3848 @group | |
3849 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3850 This is the contents of the buffer before. | |
3851 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3852 @end group | |
3853 | |
3854 @group | |
3855 (subst-char-in-region 1 20 ?i ?X) | |
3856 @result{} nil | |
3857 | |
3858 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3859 ThXs Xs the contents of the buffer before. | |
3860 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3861 @end group | |
3862 @end example | |
3863 @end defun | |
3864 | |
3865 @defun translate-region start end table | |
3866 This function applies a translation table to the characters in the | |
3867 buffer between positions @var{start} and @var{end}. | |
3868 | |
57646
3611af22c464
(translate-region): Document that it accepts also a
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
57402
diff
changeset
|
3869 The translation table @var{table} is a string or a char-table; |
3611af22c464
(translate-region): Document that it accepts also a
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
57402
diff
changeset
|
3870 @code{(aref @var{table} @var{ochar})} gives the translated character |
3611af22c464
(translate-region): Document that it accepts also a
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
57402
diff
changeset
|
3871 corresponding to @var{ochar}. If @var{table} is a string, any |
6558 | 3872 characters with codes larger than the length of @var{table} are not |
3873 altered by the translation. | |
3874 | |
3875 The return value of @code{translate-region} is the number of | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3876 characters that were actually changed by the translation. This does |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3877 not count characters that were mapped into themselves in the |
6558 | 3878 translation table. |
3879 @end defun | |
3880 | |
3881 @node Registers | |
3882 @section Registers | |
3883 @cindex registers | |
3884 | |
3885 A register is a sort of variable used in Emacs editing that can hold a | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3886 variety of different kinds of values. Each register is named by a |
52978
1a5c50faf357
Replace @sc{foo} with @acronym{FOO}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
52626
diff
changeset
|
3887 single character. All @acronym{ASCII} characters and their meta variants |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3888 (but with the exception of @kbd{C-g}) can be used to name registers. |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3889 Thus, there are 255 possible registers. A register is designated in |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3890 Emacs Lisp by the character that is its name. |
6558 | 3891 |
3892 @defvar register-alist | |
3893 This variable is an alist of elements of the form @code{(@var{name} . | |
3894 @var{contents})}. Normally, there is one element for each Emacs | |
3895 register that has been used. | |
3896 | |
3897 The object @var{name} is a character (an integer) identifying the | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3898 register. |
6558 | 3899 @end defvar |
3900 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3901 The @var{contents} of a register can have several possible types: |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3902 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3903 @table @asis |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3904 @item a number |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3905 A number stands for itself. If @code{insert-register} finds a number |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3906 in the register, it converts the number to decimal. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3907 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3908 @item a marker |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3909 A marker represents a buffer position to jump to. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3910 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3911 @item a string |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3912 A string is text saved in the register. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3913 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3914 @item a rectangle |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3915 A rectangle is represented by a list of strings. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3916 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3917 @item @code{(@var{window-configuration} @var{position})} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3918 This represents a window configuration to restore in one frame, and a |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3919 position to jump to in the current buffer. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3920 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3921 @item @code{(@var{frame-configuration} @var{position})} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3922 This represents a frame configuration to restore, and a position |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3923 to jump to in the current buffer. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3924 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3925 @item (file @var{filename}) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3926 This represents a file to visit; jumping to this value visits file |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3927 @var{filename}. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3928 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3929 @item (file-query @var{filename} @var{position}) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3930 This represents a file to visit and a position in it; jumping to this |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3931 value visits file @var{filename} and goes to buffer position |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3932 @var{position}. Restoring this type of position asks the user for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3933 confirmation first. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3934 @end table |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3935 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3936 The functions in this section return unpredictable values unless |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3937 otherwise stated. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3938 |
6558 | 3939 @defun get-register reg |
3940 This function returns the contents of the register | |
3941 @var{reg}, or @code{nil} if it has no contents. | |
3942 @end defun | |
3943 | |
3944 @defun set-register reg value | |
3945 This function sets the contents of register @var{reg} to @var{value}. | |
3946 A register can be set to any value, but the other register functions | |
3947 expect only certain data types. The return value is @var{value}. | |
3948 @end defun | |
3949 | |
3950 @deffn Command view-register reg | |
3951 This command displays what is contained in register @var{reg}. | |
3952 @end deffn | |
3953 | |
3954 @ignore | |
3955 @deffn Command point-to-register reg | |
3956 This command stores both the current location of point and the current | |
3957 buffer in register @var{reg} as a marker. | |
3958 @end deffn | |
3959 | |
3960 @deffn Command jump-to-register reg | |
3961 @deffnx Command register-to-point reg | |
3962 @comment !!SourceFile register.el | |
3963 This command restores the status recorded in register @var{reg}. | |
3964 | |
3965 If @var{reg} contains a marker, it moves point to the position stored in | |
3966 the marker. Since both the buffer and the location within the buffer | |
3967 are stored by the @code{point-to-register} function, this command can | |
3968 switch you to another buffer. | |
3969 | |
3970 If @var{reg} contains a window configuration or a frame configuration. | |
3971 @code{jump-to-register} restores that configuration. | |
3972 @end deffn | |
3973 @end ignore | |
3974 | |
3975 @deffn Command insert-register reg &optional beforep | |
3976 This command inserts contents of register @var{reg} into the current | |
3977 buffer. | |
3978 | |
3979 Normally, this command puts point before the inserted text, and the | |
3980 mark after it. However, if the optional second argument @var{beforep} | |
3981 is non-@code{nil}, it puts the mark before and point after. | |
3982 You can pass a non-@code{nil} second argument @var{beforep} to this | |
3983 function interactively by supplying any prefix argument. | |
3984 | |
3985 If the register contains a rectangle, then the rectangle is inserted | |
3986 with its upper left corner at point. This means that text is inserted | |
3987 in the current line and underneath it on successive lines. | |
3988 | |
3989 If the register contains something other than saved text (a string) or | |
3990 a rectangle (a list), currently useless things happen. This may be | |
3991 changed in the future. | |
3992 @end deffn | |
3993 | |
3994 @ignore | |
3995 @deffn Command copy-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
3996 This command copies the region from @var{start} to @var{end} into | |
3997 register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is non-@code{nil}, it deletes | |
3998 the region from the buffer after copying it into the register. | |
3999 @end deffn | |
4000 | |
4001 @deffn Command prepend-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
4002 This command prepends the region from @var{start} to @var{end} into | |
4003 register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is non-@code{nil}, it deletes | |
4004 the region from the buffer after copying it to the register. | |
4005 @end deffn | |
4006 | |
4007 @deffn Command append-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
4008 This command appends the region from @var{start} to @var{end} to the | |
4009 text already in register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is | |
4010 non-@code{nil}, it deletes the region from the buffer after copying it | |
4011 to the register. | |
4012 @end deffn | |
4013 | |
4014 @deffn Command copy-rectangle-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
4015 This command copies a rectangular region from @var{start} to @var{end} | |
4016 into register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is non-@code{nil}, it | |
4017 deletes the region from the buffer after copying it to the register. | |
4018 @end deffn | |
4019 | |
4020 @deffn Command window-configuration-to-register reg | |
4021 This function stores the window configuration of the selected frame in | |
4022 register @var{reg}. | |
4023 @end deffn | |
4024 | |
4025 @deffn Command frame-configuration-to-register reg | |
4026 This function stores the current frame configuration in register | |
4027 @var{reg}. | |
4028 @end deffn | |
4029 @end ignore | |
4030 | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4031 @node Transposition |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4032 @section Transposition of Text |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4033 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4034 This subroutine is used by the transposition commands. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4035 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4036 @defun transpose-regions start1 end1 start2 end2 &optional leave-markers |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4037 This function exchanges two nonoverlapping portions of the buffer. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4038 Arguments @var{start1} and @var{end1} specify the bounds of one portion |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4039 and arguments @var{start2} and @var{end2} specify the bounds of the |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4040 other portion. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4041 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4042 Normally, @code{transpose-regions} relocates markers with the transposed |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4043 text; a marker previously positioned within one of the two transposed |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4044 portions moves along with that portion, thus remaining between the same |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4045 two characters in their new position. However, if @var{leave-markers} |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4046 is non-@code{nil}, @code{transpose-regions} does not do this---it leaves |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4047 all markers unrelocated. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4048 @end defun |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4049 |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4050 @node Base 64 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4051 @section Base 64 Encoding |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4052 @cindex base 64 encoding |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4053 |
39168 | 4054 Base 64 code is used in email to encode a sequence of 8-bit bytes as |
52978
1a5c50faf357
Replace @sc{foo} with @acronym{FOO}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
52626
diff
changeset
|
4055 a longer sequence of @acronym{ASCII} graphic characters. It is defined in |
39208
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4056 Internet RFC@footnote{ |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4057 An RFC, an acronym for @dfn{Request for Comments}, is a numbered |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4058 Internet informational document describing a standard. RFCs are |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4059 usually written by technical experts acting on their own initiative, |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4060 and are traditionally written in a pragmatic, experience-driven |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4061 manner. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4062 }2045. This section describes the functions for |
39168 | 4063 converting to and from this code. |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4064 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4065 @defun base64-encode-region beg end &optional no-line-break |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4066 @tindex base64-encode-region |
33911 | 4067 This function converts the region from @var{beg} to @var{end} into base |
4068 64 code. It returns the length of the encoded text. An error is | |
4069 signaled if a character in the region is multibyte, i.e.@: in a | |
4070 multibyte buffer the region must contain only characters from the | |
4071 charsets @code{ascii}, @code{eight-bit-control} and | |
4072 @code{eight-bit-graphic}. | |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4073 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4074 Normally, this function inserts newline characters into the encoded |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4075 text, to avoid overlong lines. However, if the optional argument |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4076 @var{no-line-break} is non-@code{nil}, these newlines are not added, so |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4077 the output is just one long line. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4078 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4079 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4080 @defun base64-encode-string string &optional no-line-break |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4081 @tindex base64-encode-string |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4082 This function converts the string @var{string} into base 64 code. It |
33911 | 4083 returns a string containing the encoded text. As for |
4084 @code{base64-encode-region}, an error is signaled if a character in the | |
4085 string is multibyte. | |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4086 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4087 Normally, this function inserts newline characters into the encoded |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4088 text, to avoid overlong lines. However, if the optional argument |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4089 @var{no-line-break} is non-@code{nil}, these newlines are not added, so |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4090 the result string is just one long line. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4091 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4092 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4093 @defun base64-decode-region beg end |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4094 @tindex base64-decode-region |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4095 This function converts the region from @var{beg} to @var{end} from base |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4096 64 code into the corresponding decoded text. It returns the length of |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4097 the decoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4098 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4099 The decoding functions ignore newline characters in the encoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4100 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4101 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4102 @defun base64-decode-string string |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4103 @tindex base64-decode-string |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4104 This function converts the string @var{string} from base 64 code into |
51446
a3a94326d597
base64-decode-string returns unibyte string.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
50467
diff
changeset
|
4105 the corresponding decoded text. It returns a unibyte string containing the |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4106 decoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4107 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4108 The decoding functions ignore newline characters in the encoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4109 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
4110 |
39208
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4111 @node MD5 Checksum |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4112 @section MD5 Checksum |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4113 @cindex MD5 checksum |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4114 @cindex message digest computation |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4115 |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4116 MD5 cryptographic checksums, or @dfn{message digests}, are 128-bit |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4117 ``fingerprints'' of a document or program. They are used to verify |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4118 that you have an exact and unaltered copy of the data. The algorithm |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4119 to calculate the MD5 message digest is defined in Internet |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4120 RFC@footnote{ |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4121 For an explanation of what is an RFC, see the footnote in @ref{Base |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4122 64}. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4123 }1321. This section describes the Emacs facilities for computing |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4124 message digests. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4125 |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4126 @defun md5 object &optional start end coding-system noerror |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4127 This function returns the MD5 message digest of @var{object}, which |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4128 should be a buffer or a string. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4129 |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4130 The two optional arguments @var{start} and @var{end} are character |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4131 positions specifying the portion of @var{object} to compute the |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4132 message digest for. If they are @code{nil} or omitted, the digest is |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4133 computed for the whole of @var{object}. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4134 |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4135 The function @code{md5} does not compute the message digest directly |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4136 from the internal Emacs representation of the text (@pxref{Text |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4137 Representations}). Instead, it encodes the text using a coding |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4138 system, and computes the message digest from the encoded text. The |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4139 optional fourth argument @var{coding-system} specifies which coding |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4140 system to use for encoding the text. It should be the same coding |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4141 system that you used to read the text, or that you used or will use |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4142 when saving or sending the text. @xref{Coding Systems}, for more |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4143 information about coding systems. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4144 |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4145 If @var{coding-system} is @code{nil} or omitted, the default depends |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4146 on @var{object}. If @var{object} is a buffer, the default for |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4147 @var{coding-system} is whatever coding system would be chosen by |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4148 default for writing this text into a file. If @var{object} is a |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4149 string, the user's most preferred coding system (@pxref{Recognize |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4150 Coding, prefer-coding-system, the description of |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4151 @code{prefer-coding-system}, emacs, GNU Emacs Manual}) is used. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4152 |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4153 Normally, @code{md5} signals an error if the text can't be encoded |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4154 using the specified or chosen coding system. However, if |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4155 @var{noerror} is non-@code{nil}, it silently uses @code{raw-text} |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4156 coding instead. |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4157 @end defun |
ad4839873265
(MD5 Checksum): New node, documents the md5 primitive.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
39168
diff
changeset
|
4158 |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4159 @node Atomic Changes |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4160 @section Atomic Change Groups |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4161 @cindex atomic changes |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4162 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4163 In data base terminology, an @dfn{atomic} change is an indivisible |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4164 change---it can succeed entirely or it can fail entirely, but it |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4165 cannot partly succeed. A Lisp program can make a series of changes to |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4166 one or several buffers as an @dfn{atomic change group}, meaning that |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4167 either the entire series of changes will be installed in their buffers |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4168 or, in case of an error, none of them will be. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4169 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4170 To do this for one buffer, the one already current, simply write a |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4171 call to @code{atomic-change-group} around the code that makes the |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4172 changes, like this: |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4173 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4174 @example |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4175 (atomic-change-group |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4176 (insert foo) |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4177 (delete-region x y)) |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4178 @end example |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4179 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4180 @noindent |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4181 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4182 @code{atomic-change-group}, it unmakes all the changes in that buffer |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4183 that were during the execution of the body. This kind of change group |
54916 | 4184 has no effect on any other buffers---any such changes remain. |
52192
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4185 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4186 If you need something more sophisticated, such as to make changes in |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4187 various buffers constitute one atomic group, you must directly call |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4188 lower-level functions that @code{atomic-change-group} uses. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4189 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4190 @defun prepare-change-group &optional buffer |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4191 This function sets up a change group for buffer @var{buffer}, which |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4192 defaults to the current buffer. It returns a ``handle'' that |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4193 represents the change group. You must use this handle to activate the |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4194 change group and subsequently to finish it. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4195 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4196 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4197 To use the change group, you must @dfn{activate} it. You must do |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4198 this before making any changes in the text of @var{buffer}. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4199 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4200 @defun activate-change-group handle |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4201 This function activates the change group that @var{handle} designates. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4202 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4203 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4204 After you activate the change group, any changes you make in that |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4205 buffer become part of it. Once you have made all the desired changes |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4206 in the buffer, you must @dfn{finish} the change group. There are two |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4207 ways to do this: you can either accept (and finalize) all the changes, |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4208 or cancel them all. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4209 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4210 @defun accept-change-group handle |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4211 This function accepts all the changes in the change group specified by |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4212 @var{handle}, making them final. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4213 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4214 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4215 @defun cancel-change-group handle |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4216 This function cancels and undoes all the changes in the change group |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4217 specified by @var{handle}. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4218 @end defun |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4219 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4220 Your code should use @code{unwind-protect} to make sure the group is |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4221 always finished. The call to @code{activate-change-group} should be |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4222 inside the @code{unwind-protect}, in case the user types @kbd{C-g} |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4223 just after it runs. (This is one reason why |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4224 @code{prepare-change-group} and @code{activate-change-group} are |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4225 separate functions, because normally you would call |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4226 @code{prepare-change-group} before the start of that |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4227 @code{unwind-protect}.) Once you finish the group, don't use the |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4228 handle again---in particular, don't try to finish the same group |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4229 twice. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4230 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4231 To make a multibuffer change group, call @code{prepare-change-group} |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4232 once for each buffer you want to cover, then use @code{nconc} to |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4233 combine the returned values, like this: |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4234 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4235 @example |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4236 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1) |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4237 (prepare-change-group buffer-2)) |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4238 @end example |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4239 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4240 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4241 to @code{activate-change-group}, and finish it with a single call to |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4242 @code{accept-change-group} or @code{cancel-change-group}. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4243 |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4244 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4245 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4246 will get Emacs confused, so don't let it happen; the first change |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4247 group you start for any given buffer should be the last one finished. |
aeb0d981dc7e
(Insertion): Add insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51911
diff
changeset
|
4248 |
6558 | 4249 @node Change Hooks |
4250 @section Change Hooks | |
4251 @cindex change hooks | |
4252 @cindex hooks for text changes | |
4253 | |
4254 These hook variables let you arrange to take notice of all changes in | |
4255 all buffers (or in a particular buffer, if you make them buffer-local). | |
4256 See also @ref{Special Properties}, for how to detect changes to specific | |
4257 parts of the text. | |
4258 | |
4259 The functions you use in these hooks should save and restore the match | |
4260 data if they do anything that uses regular expressions; otherwise, they | |
4261 will interfere in bizarre ways with the editing operations that call | |
4262 them. | |
4263 | |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4264 @defvar before-change-functions |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4265 This variable holds a list of functions to call before any buffer |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4266 modification. Each function gets two arguments, the beginning and end |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4267 of the region that is about to change, represented as integers. The |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4268 buffer that is about to change is always the current buffer. |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4269 @end defvar |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4270 |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4271 @defvar after-change-functions |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4272 This variable holds a list of functions to call after any buffer |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4273 modification. Each function receives three arguments: the beginning and |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4274 end of the region just changed, and the length of the text that existed |
19467
d76f57ca7aba
Explain after-change-functions and chars vs bytes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18339
diff
changeset
|
4275 before the change. All three arguments are integers. The buffer that's |
d76f57ca7aba
Explain after-change-functions and chars vs bytes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18339
diff
changeset
|
4276 about to change is always the current buffer. |
d76f57ca7aba
Explain after-change-functions and chars vs bytes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18339
diff
changeset
|
4277 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
4278 The length of the old text is the difference between the buffer positions |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
4279 before and after that text as it was before the change. As for the |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
4280 changed text, its length is simply the difference between the first two |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
4281 arguments. |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4282 @end defvar |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4283 |
54120
836a9ea3b5a4
Various small changes in addition to the following:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
54041
diff
changeset
|
4284 Output of messages into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer does not |
51702
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
4285 call these functions. |
82502bf293e0
(Buffer Contents): Document current-word.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51446
diff
changeset
|
4286 |
66149
de93c7939d28
(Change Hooks): Replace `...' with `@dots{}' in `@defmac' and `@defspec'.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents:
65369
diff
changeset
|
4287 @defmac combine-after-change-calls body@dots{} |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4288 The macro executes @var{body} normally, but arranges to call the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4289 after-change functions just once for a series of several changes---if |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4290 that seems safe. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4291 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4292 If a program makes several text changes in the same area of the buffer, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4293 using the macro @code{combine-after-change-calls} around that part of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4294 the program can make it run considerably faster when after-change hooks |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4295 are in use. When the after-change hooks are ultimately called, the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4296 arguments specify a portion of the buffer including all of the changes |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4297 made within the @code{combine-after-change-calls} body. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4298 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4299 @strong{Warning:} You must not alter the values of |
31079 | 4300 @code{after-change-functions} within |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4301 the body of a @code{combine-after-change-calls} form. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4302 |
52626 | 4303 @strong{Warning:} if the changes you combine occur in widely scattered |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4304 parts of the buffer, this will still work, but it is not advisable, |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4305 because it may lead to inefficient behavior for some change hook |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4306 functions. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4307 @end defmac |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
4308 |
31079 | 4309 The two variables above are temporarily bound to @code{nil} during the |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4310 time that any of these functions is running. This means that if one of |
6558 | 4311 these functions changes the buffer, that change won't run these |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4312 functions. If you do want a hook function to make changes that run |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
4313 these functions, make it bind these variables back to their usual |
6558 | 4314 values. |
4315 | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4316 One inconvenient result of this protective feature is that you cannot |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4317 have a function in @code{after-change-functions} or |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4318 @code{before-change-functions} which changes the value of that variable. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4319 But that's not a real limitation. If you want those functions to change |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4320 the list of functions to run, simply add one fixed function to the hook, |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4321 and code that function to look in another variable for other functions |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4322 to call. Here is an example: |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4323 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4324 @example |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4325 (setq my-own-after-change-functions nil) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4326 (defun indirect-after-change-function (beg end len) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4327 (let ((list my-own-after-change-functions)) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4328 (while list |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4329 (funcall (car list) beg end len) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4330 (setq list (cdr list))))) |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4331 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4332 @group |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4333 (add-hooks 'after-change-functions |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4334 'indirect-after-change-function) |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
4335 @end group |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4336 @end example |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
4337 |
6558 | 4338 @defvar first-change-hook |
4339 This variable is a normal hook that is run whenever a buffer is changed | |
4340 that was previously in the unmodified state. | |
4341 @end defvar | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4342 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4343 @defvar inhibit-modification-hooks |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4344 @tindex inhibit-modification-hooks |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4345 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, all of the change hooks are |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4346 disabled; none of them run. This affects all the hook variables |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4347 described above in this section, as well as the hooks attached to |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4348 certain special text properties (@pxref{Special Properties}) and overlay |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4349 properties (@pxref{Overlay Properties}). |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
4350 @end defvar |
52401 | 4351 |
4352 @ignore | |
4353 arch-tag: 3721e738-a1cb-4085-bc1a-6cb8d8e1d32b | |
4354 @end ignore |